Ford Automobile 2009 Focus User Manual

Table of Contents  
All rights reserved. Reproduction by any means, electronic or mechanical  
including photocopying, recording or by any information storage and retrieval  
system or translation in whole or part is not permitted without written  
authorization from Ford Motor Company. Ford may change the contents without  
notice and without incurring obligation.  
Copyright © 2008 Ford Motor Company  
3
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
CONGRATULATIONS  
Congratulations on acquiring your new Ford. Please take the time to get  
well acquainted with your vehicle by reading this handbook. The more  
you know and understand about your vehicle, the greater the safety and  
pleasure you will derive from driving it.  
For more information on Ford Motor Company and its products visit the  
following website:  
In the United States: www.ford.com  
In Canada: www.ford.ca  
In Australia: www.ford.com.au  
In Mexico: www.ford.com.mx  
Additional owner information is given in separate publications.  
This Owner’s Guide describes every option and model variant available  
and therefore some of the items covered may not apply to your  
particular vehicle. Furthermore, due to printing cycles it may describe  
options before they are generally available.  
Remember to pass on this Owner’s Guide when reselling the vehicle. It  
is an integral part of the vehicle.  
WARNING: Fuel pump shut-off switch: In the event of an  
accident the safety switch will automatically cut off the fuel  
supply to the engine. The switch can also be activated through sudden  
vibration (e.g. collision when parking). To reset the switch, refer to the  
Fuel pump shut-off switch in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
4
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
SAFETY AND ENVIRONMENT PROTECTION  
Warning symbols in this guide  
How can you reduce the risk of personal injury to yourself or others? In  
this guide, answers to such questions are contained in comments  
highlighted by the warning triangle symbol. These comments should be  
read and observed.  
Warning symbols on your vehicle  
When you see this symbol, it is  
imperative that you consult the  
relevant section of this guide before  
touching or attempting adjustment  
of any kind.  
Protecting the environment  
We must all play our part in  
protecting the environment. Correct  
vehicle usage and the authorized  
disposal of waste, cleaning and  
lubrication materials are significant  
steps towards this aim. Information in this respect is highlighted in this  
guide with the tree symbol.  
CALIFORNIA Proposition 65 Warning  
WARNING: Engine exhaust, some of its constituents, and  
certain vehicle components contain or emit chemicals known to  
the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other  
reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and  
certain products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known  
to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other  
reproductive harm.  
5
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
PERCHLORATE MATERIAL  
Certain components of this vehicle such as airbag modules, seat belt  
pretensioners, and button cell batteries may contain Perchlorate Material  
– Special handling may apply for service or vehicle end of life disposal.  
See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.  
BREAKING-IN YOUR VEHICLE  
Your vehicle does not need an extensive break-in. Try not to drive  
continuously at the same speed for the first 1,000 miles (1,600 km) of  
new vehicle operation. Vary your speed frequently in order to give the  
moving parts a chance to break in.  
Do not add friction modifier compounds or special break-in oils since  
these additives may prevent piston ring seating. See Engine oil in the  
Maintenance and Specifications chapter for more information on oil  
usage.  
SPECIAL NOTICES  
New Vehicle Limited Warranty  
For a detailed description of what is covered and what is not covered by  
your vehicle’s New Vehicle Limited Warranty, refer to the Warranty  
Guide/Customer Information Guide that is provided to you along with  
your Owner’s Guide.  
Special instructions  
For your added safety, your vehicle is fitted with sophisticated electronic  
controls.  
WARNING: Please read the section Airbag Supplemental  
Restraint System (SRS) in the Seating and Safety Restraints  
chapter. Failure to follow the specific warnings and instructions could  
result in personal injury.  
WARNING: Front seat mounted rear-facing child or infant seats  
should NEVER be placed in front of an active passenger airbag.  
6
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
Service Data Recording  
Service data recorders in your vehicle are capable of collecting and  
storing diagnostic information about your vehicle. This potentially  
includes information about the performance or status of various systems  
and modules in the vehicle, such as engine, throttle, steering or brake  
systems. In order to properly diagnose and service your vehicle, Ford  
Motor Company, Ford of Canada, and service and repair facilities may  
access vehicle diagnostic information through a direct connection to your  
vehicle when diagnosing or servicing your vehicle. For U.S. only (if  
equipped), if you choose to use the SYNCVehicle Health Report, you  
consent that certain diagnostic information may also be accessed  
electronically by Ford Motor Company and Ford authorized service  
facilities, and that the diagnostic information may be used for any  
purpose. See your SYNCsupplement for more information.  
Event Data Recording  
Other modules in your vehicle — event data recorders — are capable of  
collecting and storing data during a crash or near crash event. The  
recorded information may assist in the investigation of such an event.  
The modules may record information about both the vehicle and the  
occupants, potentially including information such as:  
how various systems in your vehicle were operating;  
whether or not the driver and passenger seatbelts were buckled;  
how far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator and/or the  
brake pedal;  
how fast the vehicle was traveling; and  
where the driver was positioning the steering wheel.  
7
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
To access this information, special equipment must be directly connected  
to the recording modules. Ford Motor Company and Ford of Canada do  
not access event data recorder information without obtaining consent,  
unless pursuant to court order or where required by law enforcement,  
other government authorities or other third parties acting with lawful  
authority. Other parties may seek to access the information  
independently of Ford Motor Company and Ford of Canada. Please note  
that once 911 Assist (if equipped) is enabled (set ON), 911 Assist may,  
through any paired and connected cell phone, disclose to emergency  
services that the vehicle has been in a crash involving the deployment of  
an airbag or, in certain vehicles, the activation of the fuel pump shut-off.  
Certain versions or updates to 911 Assist may also be capable of  
electronically or verbally disclosing to 911 operators the vehicle location,  
and/or other details about the vehicle or crash to assist 911 operators to  
provide the most appropriate emergency services. If you do not want to  
disclose this information, do not activate the feature. See your SYNC௡  
supplement for more information.  
Important information for P215/45R17 low-profile tires and wheels  
If your vehicle is equipped with P215/45R17 tires, they are low-profile  
tires. These tires and wheels are designed to give your vehicle a sport  
appearance. With low-profile tires, you may notice an increase in road  
noise and faster tire wear, depending on road conditions and driving  
styles. Due to their design, low-profile tires and wheels are more prone  
to road damage from potholes, rough or unpaved roads, car wash rails  
and curb contact than standard tires and wheels. Your vehicle’s warranty  
does not cover these types of damage. Tires should always be kept at the  
correct inflation pressures and extra caution should be taken when  
operating on rough roads to avoid impacts that could cause wheel and  
tire damage.  
8
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Cell phone use  
The use of Mobile Communications Equipment has become increasingly  
important in the conduct of business and personal affairs. However,  
drivers must not compromise their own or others’ safety when using  
such equipment. Mobile Communications can enhance personal safety  
and security when appropriately used, particularly in emergency  
situations. Safety must be paramount when using mobile communications  
equipment to avoid negating these benefits.  
Mobile Communication Equipment includes, but is not limited to cellular  
phones, pagers, portable email devices, in-vehicle communications  
systems, telematics devices and portable two-way radios.  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Export unique (Non–United States/Canada) vehicle specific  
information  
For your particular global region, your vehicle may be equipped with  
features and options that are different from the features and options that  
are described in this Owner’s Guide. A market unique supplement may  
be supplied that complements this book. By referring to the market  
unique supplement, if provided, you can properly identify those features,  
recommendations and specifications that are unique to your vehicle. This  
Owner’s Guide is written primarily for the U.S. and Canadian Markets.  
Features or equipment listed as standard may be different on units built  
for Export. Refer to this Owner’s Guide for all other required  
information and warnings.  
9
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
These are some of the symbols you may see on your vehicle.  
Vehicle Symbol Glossary  
Safety Alert  
See Owner’s Guide  
Airbag - Front  
Fasten Safety Belt  
Airbag - Side  
Child Seat Lower  
Anchor  
Child Seat Tether  
Anchor  
Brake System  
Anti-Lock Brake System  
Parking Brake System  
Brake Fluid -  
Non-Petroleum Based  
Parking Aid System  
Speed Control  
Stability Control System  
Master Lighting Switch  
Fog Lamps-Front  
Hazard Warning Flasher  
Fuse Compartment  
Windshield Wash/Wipe  
Fuel Pump Reset  
Windshield  
Rear Window  
Defrost/Demist  
Defrost/Demist  
10  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Vehicle Symbol Glossary  
Power Window Lockout  
Interior Luggage  
Power Windows  
Front/Rear  
Child Safety Door  
Lock/Unlock  
Compartment Release  
Panic Alarm  
Engine Oil  
Engine Coolant  
Temperature  
Engine Coolant  
Do Not Open When Hot  
Battery  
Avoid Smoking, Flames,  
or Sparks  
Battery Acid  
Fan Warning  
Explosive Gas  
MAX  
MIN  
Maintain Correct Fluid  
Level  
Power Steering Fluid  
Service Engine Soon  
Engine Air Filter  
Jack  
Passenger Compartment  
Air Filter  
Low Tire Pressure  
Warning  
Check Fuel Cap  
11  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
WARNING LIGHTS AND CHIMES  
Standard instrument cluster  
Optional instrument cluster  
Warning lights and gauges can alert you to a vehicle condition that may  
become serious enough to cause expensive repairs. A warning light may  
illuminate when a problem exists with one of your vehicle’s functions.  
Many lights will illuminate when you start your vehicle to make sure the  
bulb works. If any light remains on after starting the vehicle, refer to the  
respective system warning light for additional information.  
12  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
Service engine soon: The Service  
engine soon indicator light  
illuminates when the ignition is first  
turned to the on position to check  
the bulb and to indicate whether the vehicle is ready for  
Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) testing. Normally, the “Service engine  
soon” light will stay on until the engine is cranked, then turn itself off if  
no malfunctions are present. However, if after 15 seconds the “Service  
engine soon” light blinks eight times, it means that the vehicle is not  
ready for I/M testing. See the Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance  
(I/M) testing in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
Solid illumination after the engine is started indicates the On Board  
Diagnostics System (OBD-II) has detected a malfunction. Refer to On  
board diagnostics (OBD-II) in the Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter. If the light is blinking, engine misfire is occurring which could  
damage your catalytic converter. Drive in a moderate fashion (avoid  
heavy acceleration and deceleration) and have your vehicle serviced  
immediately by your authorized dealer.  
WARNING: Under engine misfire conditions, excessive exhaust  
temperatures could damage the catalytic converter, the fuel  
system, interior floor coverings or other vehicle components, possibly  
causing a fire.  
Check fuel cap: Illuminates when  
the fuel cap may not be properly  
installed. Continued driving with  
this light on may cause the Service  
engine soon warning light to come  
on, refer to Fuel filler cap in the  
Maintenance and Specification chapter.  
Brake system warning light: To  
confirm the brake system warning  
light is functional, it will  
momentarily illuminate when the  
ignition is turned to the on position  
!
P
BRAKE  
when the engine is not running, or in a position between on and start, or  
by applying the parking brake when the ignition is turned to the on  
position. If the brake system warning light does not illuminate at this  
time, seek service immediately from your authorized dealer. Illumination  
13  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
after releasing the parking brake indicates low brake fluid level and the  
brake system should be inspected immediately by your authorized dealer.  
WARNING: Driving a vehicle with the brake system warning  
light on is dangerous. A significant decrease in braking  
performance may occur. It will take you longer to stop the vehicle.  
Have the vehicle checked by your authorized dealer. Driving extended  
distances with the parking brake engaged can cause brake failure and  
the risk of personal injury.  
Anti-lock brake system (if  
equipped): If the ABS light stays  
ABS  
illuminated or continues to flash, a  
malfunction has been detected, have  
the system serviced immediately by  
your authorized dealer. Normal braking is still functional unless the brake  
warning light also is illuminated.  
Airbag readiness: If this light fails  
to illuminate when the ignition is  
turned to on, continues to flash or  
remains on, have the system  
serviced immediately by your authorized dealer. A chime will sound  
when there is a malfunction in the indicator light.  
Safety belt: Reminds you to fasten  
your safety belt. A Belt-Minder௡  
chime will also sound to remind you  
to fasten your safety belt. Refer to  
the Seating and Safety Restraints  
chapter to activate/deactivate the Belt-Minderchime feature.  
Charging system: Illuminates when  
the battery is not charging properly.  
If it stays on while the engine is  
running, there may be a malfunction  
with the charging system. Contact your authorized dealer as soon as  
possible. This indicates a problem with the electrical system or a related  
component.  
Engine oil pressure: Illuminates  
when the oil pressure falls below the  
normal range, refer to Engine oil in  
the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
14  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Engine coolant temperature:  
Illuminates when the engine coolant  
temperature is high. Stop the  
vehicle as soon as possible, switch off the engine and let cool. Refer to  
Engine coolant in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the  
engine is running or hot.  
Anti-theft system: Flashes when  
the SecuriLock™ Passive Anti-theft  
system has been activated.  
Overdrive off (if equipped):  
O/D  
Illuminates when the overdrive  
OFF  
function of the transaxle has been  
turned off, refer to the Driving  
chapter. If the light flashes steadily or does not illuminate, have the  
transmission serviced soon, or damage may occur.  
Speed control (if equipped):  
Illuminates when the speed control  
is activated. Turns off when the  
speed control system is deactivated,  
refer to the Driver Controls  
chapter for more information.  
Upshift (if equipped): To  
maximize fuel economy, this light  
illuminates when the manual  
transmission should be shifted to  
the next highest gear. Refer to the Driving chapter for more  
information.  
Low tire pressure warning:  
Illuminates when your tire pressure  
is low. If the light remains on at  
start up or while driving, the tire  
pressure should be checked. Refer  
to Inflating your tires in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter. When  
the ignition is first turned to on, the light will illuminate for three  
seconds to ensure the bulb is working. If the light does not turn on or  
begins to flash, have the system inspected by your authorized dealer. For  
15  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
more information on this system, refer to Tire pressure monitoring  
system (TPMS) in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter.  
AdvanceTrac/Traction  
Control™ system (if equipped):  
Illuminates when the  
AdvanceTrac/Traction Control™ is  
turned off and will flash when  
active. If the light remains on, have  
the system serviced immediately, refer to the Driving chapter for more  
information.  
Throttle Control/Transmission:  
Illuminates when a powertrain fault  
has been detected. Contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as  
possible.  
Low fuel: Illuminates when the fuel  
level in the fuel tank is at or near  
empty (refer to Fuel gauge in this  
chapter).  
Door ajar: Illuminates when the  
ignition is in the on position and any  
door is open.  
Turn signal: Illuminates when the  
left or right turn signal or the  
hazard lights are turned on. If the  
indicators stay on or flash faster, check for a burned out bulb.  
High beams: Illuminates when the  
high beam headlamps are turned on.  
Key-in-ignition warning chime: Sounds when the key is left in the  
ignition in the off or accessory position and the driver’s door is opened.  
Headlamps on warning chime: Sounds when the headlamps or parking  
lamps are on, the ignition is off (the key is not in the ignition) and the  
driver’s door is opened.  
16  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
GAUGES  
Speedometer: Indicates the  
current vehicle speed.  
Engine coolant temperature  
gauge: Indicates engine coolant  
temperature. At normal operating  
temperature, the needle will be in  
the normal range. If it enters the  
red section, the engine is  
overheating. Stop the vehicle as  
soon as safely possible, switch  
off the engine and let the engine cool. If it enters the red section  
and the Service engine soon indicator light illuminates, refer to How  
fail safe cooling works in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the  
engine is running or hot.  
17  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
Odometer: Registers the total miles  
(kilometers) of the vehicle.  
If equipped with a message center,  
refer to Message center in the  
Driver Controls chapter on how to  
switch the display from Metric to English.  
Trip odometer: Registers the miles (kilometers) of individual journeys.  
Standard instrument cluster:  
Press the SELECT/RESET control  
once to switch from the odometer to  
the TRIP A feature. Press the  
control again to select the TRIP B  
feature. To reset the trip, press and  
hold the control again until the trip reading is 0.0 miles.  
Optional instrument cluster:  
Press and release the message  
center INFO button until TRIP A  
mode appears in the display. Press  
the control again to select the TRIP  
B feature. Press and hold the  
RESET button to reset.  
Tachometer: Indicates the engine  
speed in revolutions per minute.  
Driving with your tachometer  
pointer continuously at the top of  
the scale may damage the engine.  
Fuel gauge: Indicates  
approximately how much fuel is left  
in the fuel tank (when the ignition  
is in the on position). The fuel  
gauge may vary slightly when the  
vehicle is in motion or on a grade.  
Refer to Filling the tank in the  
Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter for more information.  
18  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
AUDIO SYSTEMS  
AM/FM/single CD or in-dash CD6/MP3 satellite compatible sound  
system  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Accessory delay: Your vehicle is equipped with accessory delay. With  
this feature, the radio and other electrical accessories may be used for  
up to ten minutes after the ignition is turned off or until either front  
door is opened.  
Note: Your vehicle is equipped with  
a unique audio system. If your  
display shows six small circles in the  
display, your audio system is a CD6  
system. If not, your system is a  
Single CD system.  
Setting the clock  
To set the time, press CLOCK#. The display will read SET TIME. Use the  
memory preset numbers (0–9) to enter in the desired time–hours and  
minutes. The clock will then begin from that time.  
19  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
AM/FM Radio  
/ VOL (Power/Volume): Press  
to turn the radio on/off. Turn the  
knob to increase/decrease volume.  
If the volume is set above a certain  
level and the ignition is turned off,  
the volume will come back on at a  
nominal listening level when the  
ignition switch is turned back on.  
AM/FM: Press repeatedly to select AM/FM1/FM2 frequency band.  
TUNE: Turn the knob to go  
up/down the frequency band in  
individual increments.  
DIRECT: Press DIRECT and then select the desired radio frequency  
(i.e. 93.9) using the memory preset numbers (0–9).  
SEEK/TRACK: Press  
SEEK/TRACK  
to access the  
previous/next strong radio station.  
SCAN: Press for a brief sampling of all strong radio stations.  
MEMORY PRESETS (0–9): When  
tuned to any station, press and hold  
a preset button until sound returns  
and PRESET # SAVED appears in  
the display. You can save up to 30  
stations, 10 in AM, 10 in FM1 and FM2.  
Saving presets automatically– Autoset allows you to set the strongest  
local radio stations without losing your original manually set preset  
stations for AM/FM1/FM2.  
To activate the autoset feature: Press MENU repeatedly until AUTO  
PRESET ON/OFF appears in the display. Use  
SEEK/TRACK  
to  
toggle AUTO PRESET to ON, and either wait five seconds for the search  
to initiate or press OK to immediately initiate the search. If you press  
20  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
another control within those five seconds, the search will not initiate.  
The 10 strongest stations will be filled and the station stored in preset 1  
will begin playing.  
If there are fewer then 10 strong stations, the system will store the last  
one in the remaining presets.  
RDS Radio  
Available only in FM mode. This feature allows you to search  
RDS-equipped stations for a certain category of music format: CLASSIC,  
COUNTRY, JAZZ/RB, ROCK, etc.  
To activate: Press MENU repeatedly until RDS (ON/OFF) appears in the  
display. Use  
SEEK/TRACK  
to toggle RDS ON/OFF. When RDS is  
OFF, you will not be able to search for RDS equipped stations or view  
the station name or type.  
CAT/FOLD(Category/Folder): This feature allows you to select from  
various music categories.  
To change RDS categories: Press MENU repeatedly until RDS ON/OFF  
appears in the display. Use  
PRESS UP OR DOWN TO CHANGE RDS CATEGORY will appear in the  
display. Press to scroll through all possible categories. When the  
desired category appears in the display, press SEEK/TRACK to  
/
to toggle RDS to ON. Press CAT.  
/
find the next station playing that selection or press SCAN for a brief  
sampling of all stations playing that category of music.  
CD/MP3 Player  
CD: Press to enter CD/MP3 mode. If a disc is already loaded into the  
system, CD/MP3 play will begin where it ended last. If no CD is loaded,  
NO DISC will appear in the display.  
LOAD:  
For a single CD system– This control is not operational. To load a CD,  
simply insert the disc, label side up, into the CD slot.  
For a CD6 system– Press LOAD. When the display reads SELECT  
SLOT, choose the desired slot number using memory presets 1–6. When  
the display reads LOAD CD#, load the desired disc, label side up. If you  
do not choose a slot within five seconds, the system will choose for you.  
Once loaded, the first track will begin to play.  
To auto load up to six discs– Press and hold LOAD until the display  
reads AUTOLOAD#. Load the desired disc, label side up. The system will  
prompt you to load discs for the remaining available slots. Insert the  
21  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
discs, one at a time, label side up, when prompted. Once loaded, the disc  
in preset #1 will begin to play.  
Press the number preset buttons (1–6) to choose the disc you want to  
play.  
EJECT:  
For a single CD system– press EJECT to eject the CD.  
For a CD6 system– press EJECT and select the desired CD slot by  
pressing the corresponding memory preset #. The display will read  
EJECTING #. When the system has ejected the CD, the display will read  
REMOVE CD #. Remove the CD. If you do not remove the CD, the  
system will reload the disc.  
To auto eject all loaded discs– Press and hold EJECT. The system will  
eject all discs and prompt you when to remove them.  
/
Play/Pause: Press to  
play/pause a track when playing a  
CD.  
SEEK/TRACK: Press  
SEEK/TRACK  
to access the  
previous/next track.  
CAT (Category) / FOLD (Folder):  
In MP3 mode only– Press CAT/FOLD and then press  
SEEK/TRACK  
to access the previous/next folder.  
SCAN: Press for a brief sampling of all tracks on the current disc or  
MP3 folder.  
DIRECT:  
In CD mode– Press DIRECT. The display will read DIRECT TRACK  
MODE SELECT TRACK. Enter the desired track number using the  
memory preset buttons (0–9). The system will then begin playing that  
track.  
In MP3 folder mode– Press DIRECT and the memory preset buttons  
(0–9) of the desired folder. The system will advance to that specific  
folder.  
22  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
TEXT:  
In MP3 mode only– Press TEXT repeatedly to view Album (AL), Folder  
(FL), Song (SO) and Artist (AR) in the display, if available.  
In TEXT MODE: Sometimes the display requires additional text to be  
displayed. When the < / > indicator is active, press TEXT and then  
press  
COMPRESSION: Press MENU repeatedly until COMPRESSION ON/OFF  
appears in the display. Use SEEK/TRACK to toggle between  
SEEK/TRACK  
to view the additional display text.  
ON/OFF. When COMPRESSION is ON, the system will bring the soft and  
loud CD passages together for a more consistent listening level.  
SHUFFLE: Press MENU repeatedly until SHUFFLE ON/OFF appears in  
the display. Use  
SEEK/TRACK  
to toggle between ON/OFF. If  
you wish to engage shuffle mode right away, press  
SEEK/TRACK  
to begin random play. Otherwise, random play will  
begin when the current track is finished playing. The system will only  
shuffle the currently playing disc.  
Satellite Radio (if equipped)  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
SIRIUS: Press repeatedly to access satellite radio mode, if equipped.  
Press repeatedly to cycle through SAT1, SAT2 and SAT3 modes.  
TUNE/OK: Turn the knob to go to  
the next / previous available SIRIUS  
satellite station.  
DIRECT: Press DIRECT then enter the desired channel (i.e. 002) using  
the memory preset buttons (0–9). If you only enter one digit, press OK  
and the system will go to that satellite channel. If you enter three digits,  
the system will automatically go to that channel, if available. You may  
cancel your entry by pressing DIRECT. If an invalid station number is  
entered, INVALID CHANNEL will appear in the display and the system  
will continue playing the current station.  
23  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
SEEK/TRACK: Press  
SEEK/TRACK  
to seek to the  
previous/next channel. If a specific  
category is selected, (Jazz, Rock,  
News, etc.), press  
SEEK/TRACK  
previous/next channel in the selected category. Press and hold  
SEEK/TRACK to fast seek through the previous/next channels.  
to seek to the  
SCAN: Press SCAN for a brief sampling of all available SIRIUS satellite  
channels. If a specific category is selected, (Jazz, Rock, News, etc.) press  
SCAN for a brief sampling of all available SIRIUS satellite channels within  
the selected category.  
MEMORY PRESETS (0–9): There  
are 30 available presets, 10 each for  
SAT1, SAT2 and SAT3. To save  
satellite channels in your memory  
presets, tune to the desired channel  
then press and hold a memory preset number (0–9) until sound returns.  
TEXT: Press and release to display the artist and song title. While in  
TEXT MODE, press again to scroll through the Artist (AR), Song (SO),  
Channel (CH) and Category (CA).  
In TEXT MODE: Sometimes the display requires additional text to be  
displayed. When the < / > indicator is active, press TEXT and then  
press  
SEEK/TRACK  
to view the additional display text.  
CAT (Category) / FOLD (Folder): Press to toggle between turning  
the most recently selected satellite radio category on or off. The category  
icon (CAT) will illuminate in the display when a specific category is  
selected (the icon will not illuminate during CATEGORY ALL). If no  
category has ever been selected, NO CATEGORY SELECTED will display.  
Note: Separate categories can be set for SAT1, SAT2 or SAT3.  
Refer to Satellite radio menu for further information on selecting a  
satellite radio category.  
SATELLITE RADIO MENU: Press MENU when satellite radio mode is  
active to access. Press OK to enter into the satellite radio menu.  
Press  
CATEGORY MENU- Press OK to enter category mode.  
Press to scroll through the list of available SIRIUS channel  
Categories (Pop, Rock, News, etc.) Press OK when the desired  
/
to cycle through the following options:  
/
24  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
category appears in the display. After a category is selected,  
press to search for that specific category of channels only  
/
(i.e. ROCK). You may also select CATEGORY ALL to seek all available  
SIRIUS categories and channels. Press OK to close and return to the  
main menu.  
SONG SEEK MENU- Press OK to enter song seek menu.  
Press  
/
to scroll through the following options:  
a. SAVE THIS SONG: Press OK to save the currently playing song’s  
title in the system’s memory. (If you try to save something other than  
a song, CANT SAVE will appear in the display.) When the chosen song  
is playing on any satellite radio channel, the system will alert you with  
an audible prompt. Press OK while SONG ALERT is in the display and  
the system will take you to the channel playing the desired song. You  
can save up to 20 song titles. If you attempt to save more than 20  
titles, the display will read REPLACE SONG? Press OK to access the  
saved titles and press  
/
to cycle through the saved titles. When  
the song title appears in the display that you would like to replace,  
press OK. SONG REPLACED will appear in the display.  
b. DELETE A SONG: Press OK to delete a song from the system’s  
memory. Press  
/
to cycle through the saved songs. When the  
song appears in the display that you would like to delete, press OK.  
The song will appear in the display for confirmation. Press OK again  
and the display will read SONG DELETED. If you do not want to  
delete the currently listed song, press  
RETURN or CANCEL.  
/
to select either  
Note: If there are no songs presently saved, the display will read NO  
SONGS.  
c. DELETE ALL SONGS: Press OK to delete all song’s from the  
system’s memory. The display will read ARE YOU SURE ? Press OK to  
confirm deletion of all saved songs and the display will read ALL  
DELETED.  
Note: If there are no songs presently saved, the display will read NO  
SONGS.  
d. DISABLE ALERTS/ENABLE ALERTS: Press OK to  
enable/disable the satellite alert status which alerts you when your  
selected songs are playing on a satellite radio channel. (The system  
default is disabled.) SONG ALERTS ENABLED/DISABLED will appear  
in the display. The menu listing will display the opposite state. For  
example, if you have chosen to enable the song alerts, the menu  
listing will read DISABLE as the alerts are currently on, so your other  
option is to turn them off.  
25  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
CHANNEL LOCKOUT MENU- Press OK to enter the Channel  
Lockout menu. Press the  
options:  
/
to scroll through the following  
a. LOCK/UNLOCK THIS CHANNEL: Press OK when  
LOCK/UNLOCK THIS CHANNEL is displayed and the display will read  
ENTER PIN. Enter your four-digit PIN number (initial PIN is 1234)  
and the system will lock/unlock the channel and CHANNEL LOCKED  
or UNLOCKED will be displayed.  
Note: you must be tuned to the specific channel you want to  
lock/unlock when using this feature.  
b. CHANGE PIN: Press OK when CHANGE PIN is displayed. The  
display will read ENTER OLD PIN. Enter your current (old) PIN  
number and when the system accepts your entry it will display  
ENTER NEW PIN. Enter your new four-digit PIN and the system will  
save the new PIN and PIN SAVED will display.  
c. UNLOCK ALL CHANNELS: Press OK when UNLOCK ALL  
CHANNELS is displayed and the display will read ENTER PIN. Enter  
your four-digit PIN and the system will unlock all channels and the  
display will read CHANNEL UNLOCKED.  
d. RESET PIN: Press OK when RESET PIN is displayed. The display  
will read ARE YOUR SURE. Press OK again to automatically reset the  
PIN number to its initial password setting (1234). PIN RESET TO  
DEFAULT PIN will be displayed.  
e. RETURN: Press OK when RETURN is displayed and the system  
will exit back to the satellite radio menu.  
Sound Adjustments  
Press SOUND repeatedly to cycle through the following features:  
BASS: Press  
SEEK/TRACK  
SEEK/TRACK  
SEEK/TRACK  
to adjust the level of bass.  
to adjust the level of treble.  
to adjust the audio between  
TREBLE: Press  
BALANCE: Press  
the left (L) and right (R) speakers.  
FADE: Press SEEK/TRACK  
back (B) and front (F) speakers.  
to adjust the audio between the  
SPEED COMPENSATED VOLUME: With this feature on, radio volume  
automatically gets louder with increasing vehicle speed to compensate  
for road and wind noise.  
The default setting is off.  
26  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Use  
SEEK/TRACK  
to adjust between SPEED OFF and levels  
1–7: Increasing the level from 1 (lowest setting) to 7 (highest setting)  
allows the radio volume to automatically change slightly with vehicle  
speed to compensate for road and wind noise.  
Recommended level is 1–3; SPEED OFF turns the feature off and level 7  
is the maximum setting.  
ALL SEATS (Occupancy mode, if equipped): Press SOUND  
repeatedly to reach the Occupancy mode setting. Press  
SEEK/TRACK  
to select and optimize sound for ALL SEATS,  
DRIVERS SEAT or REAR SEATS.  
Extra Features  
AUX: Press repeatedly to cycle through LINE IN (auxiliary audio mode),  
and SYNC (if equipped).  
For location and further information on auxiliary audio mode, refer to  
Auxiliary input jack later in this chapter.  
If your vehicle is equipped with SYNC, refer to the SYNC information  
included with your vehicle for further information.  
OK: Your vehicle may be equipped  
with special phone and media  
features which will require you to  
confirm commands by pressing OK.  
Refer to the SYNC information  
included with your vehicle for  
further information.  
(Phone): If your vehicle is equipped with SYNC, press to access  
SYNC PHONE features. Refer to the SYNC information included with  
your vehicle for further information.  
If your vehicle is not equipped with SYNC, the display will read NO  
PHONE.  
Auxiliary input jack (Line in)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
27  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
The Auxiliary Input Jack provides a  
way to connect your portable music  
player to the in-vehicle audio  
system. This allows the audio from a  
portable music player to be played  
through the vehicle speakers with  
high fidelity. To achieve optimal  
performance, please observe the  
following instructions when  
attaching your portable music  
device to the audio system.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a navigation system, refer to Auxiliary  
input jack section in the Audio features chapter of your Navigation  
system supplement.  
Required equipment:  
1. Any portable music player designed to be used with headphones  
2. An audio extension cable with stereo male 1/8 in. (3.5 mm)  
connectors at each end  
To play your portable music player using the auxiliary input jack:  
1. Begin with the vehicle parked and the radio turned off.  
2. Ensure that the battery in your portable music player is new or fully  
charged and that the device is turned off.  
3. Attach one end of the audio extension cable to the headphone output  
of your player and the other end of the audio extension cable to the AIJ  
in your vehicle.  
4. Turn the radio on, using either a tuned FM station or a CD loaded into  
the system. Adjust the volume to a comfortable listening level.  
5. Turn the portable music player on and adjust the volume to 1/2 the  
volume.  
6. Press AUX on the vehicle radio repeatedly until LINE, LINE IN or  
SYNC LINE IN appears in the display.  
You should hear audio from your portable music player although it may  
be low.  
7. Adjust the sound on your portable music player until it reaches the  
level of the FM station or CD by switching back and forth between the  
AUX and FM or CD controls.  
Troubleshooting:  
1. Do not connect the audio input jack to a line level output. Line level  
outputs are intended for connection to a home stereo and are not  
28  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
compatible with the AIJ. The AIJ will only work correctly with devices  
that have a headphone output with a volume control.  
2. Do not set the portable music player’s volume level higher than is  
necessary to match the volume of the CD or FM radio in your audio  
system as this will cause distortion and will reduce sound quality. Many  
portable music players have different output levels, so not all players  
should be set at the same levels. Some players will sound best at full  
volume and others will need to be set at a lower volume.  
3. If the music sounds distorted at lower listening levels, turn the  
portable music player volume down. If the problems persists, replace or  
recharge the batteries in the portable music player.  
4. The portable music player must be controlled in the same manner  
when it is used with headphones as the AIJ does not provide control  
(play, pause, etc.) over the attached portable music player.  
5. For safety reasons, connecting or adjusting the settings on your  
portable music player should not be attempted while the vehicle is  
moving. Also, the portable music player should be stored in a secure  
location, such as the center console or the glove box, when the vehicle is  
in motion. The audio extension cable must be long enough to allow the  
portable music player to be safely stored while the vehicle is in motion.  
USB port (if equipped)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a  
USB port inside your center console.  
This feature allows you to plug in  
media playing devices, memory  
sticks, and also to charge devices if  
they support this feature. For  
further information on this feature,  
refer to Accessing and using your  
USB port in the SYNC supplement  
or Navigation system supplement.  
29  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
GENERAL AUDIO INFORMATION  
Radio frequencies:  
AM and FM frequencies are established by the Federal Communications  
Commission (FCC) and the Canadian Radio and Telecommunications  
Commission (CRTC). Those frequencies are:  
AM: 530, 540–1700, 1710 kHz  
FM: 87.7, 87.9–107.7, 107.9 MHz  
Radio reception factors:  
There are three factors that can affect radio reception:  
Distance/strength: The further you travel from an FM station, the  
weaker the signal and the weaker the reception.  
Terrain: Hills, mountains, tall buildings, power lines, electric fences,  
traffic lights and thunderstorms can interfere with your reception.  
Station overload: When you pass a broadcast tower, a stronger signal  
may overtake a weaker one and play while the weak station frequency  
is displayed.  
CD/CD player care  
Do:  
Handle discs by their edges only.  
(Never touch the playing  
surface).  
Inspect discs before playing.  
Clean only with an approved CD  
cleaner.  
Wipe discs from the center out.  
Don’t:  
Expose discs to direct sunlight or heat sources for extended periods  
of time.  
Clean using a circular motion.  
30  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
CD units are designed to play commercially pressed 4.75 in  
(12 cm) audio compact discs only. Due to technical  
incompatibility, certain recordable and re-recordable compact  
discs may not function correctly when used in Ford CD players.  
Do not use any irregular shaped  
CDs or discs with a scratch  
protection film attached.  
CDs with homemade paper  
(adhesive) labels should not be  
inserted into the CD player as  
the label may peel and cause the  
CD to become jammed. It is  
recommended that homemade  
CDs be identified with  
permanent felt tip marker rather  
than adhesive labels. Ballpoint pens may damage CDs. Please  
contact your authorized dealer for further information.  
Audio system warranty and service  
Refer to the Warranty Guide/Customer Information Guide for audio  
system warranty information. If service is necessary, see your dealer or  
qualified technician.  
MP3 track and folder structure  
Your MP3 system recognizes MP3 individual tracks and folder structure  
as follows:  
There are two different modes for MP3 disc playback: MP3 track mode  
(system default) and MP3 folder mode. For more information on track  
and folder mode, refer to Sample MP3 structure in the following  
section.  
MP3 track mode ignores any folder structure on the MP3 disc. The  
player numbers each MP3 track on the disc (noted by the .mp3 file  
extension) from T001 to a maximum of T255.  
Note: The maximum number of playable MP3 files may be less  
depending on the structure of the CD and exact model of radio  
present.  
31  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
MP3 folder mode represents a folder structure consisting of one level  
of folders. The CD player numbers all MP3 tracks on the disc (noted  
by the .mp3 file extension) and all folders containing MP3 files, from  
F001 (folder) T001 (track) to F253 T255.  
Creating discs with only one level of folders will help with navigation  
through the disc files.  
Sample MP3 structure  
If you are burning your own MP3  
discs, it is important to understand  
how the system will read the  
structures you create. While various  
files may be present, (files with  
extensions other than mp3), only  
files with the .mp3 extension will be  
played. Other files will be ignored  
by the system. This enables you to  
use the same MP3 disc for a variety  
of tasks on your work computer,  
home computer and your in vehicle  
system.  
.mp3  
.mp3  
1
1
2
3
.mp3  
2
3
4
5
.mp3  
.mp3  
.mp3  
4
6
7
.mp3  
.doc  
.ppt  
.xls  
In track mode, the system will display and play the structure as if it were  
only one level deep (all .mp3 files will be played, regardless of being in a  
specific folder). In folder mode, the system will only play the .mp3 files  
in the current folder.  
Satellite radio information (if equipped)  
Satellite radio channels: SIRIUS broadcasts a variety of music, news,  
sports, weather, traffic and entertainment satellite radio channels. For  
more information and a complete list of SIRIUS satellite radio channels,  
visit www.sirius.com in the United States, www.sirius-canada.ca in  
Canada, or call SIRIUS at 1–888–539–7474.  
32  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Satellite radio reception factors: To receive the satellite signal, your  
vehicle has been equipped with a satellite radio antenna located on the  
roof of your vehicle. The vehicle roof provides the best location for an  
unobstructed, open view of the sky, a requirement of a satellite radio  
system. Like AM/FM, there are several factors that can affect satellite  
radio reception performance:  
Antenna obstructions: For optimal reception performance, keep the  
antenna clear of snow and ice build-up and keep luggage and other  
material as far away from the antenna as possible.  
Terrain: Hills, mountains, tall buildings, bridges, tunnels, freeway  
overpasses, parking garages, dense tree foliage and thunderstorms can  
interfere with your reception.  
Station overload: When you pass a ground based broadcast repeating  
tower, a stronger signal may overtake a weaker one and result in an  
audio mute.  
Unlike AM/FM audible static, you will hear an audio mute when there is  
a satellite radio signal interference. Your radio display may display NO  
SIGNAL to indicate the interference.  
SIRIUS satellite radio service: SIRIUS Satellite Radio is a subscription  
based satellite radio service that broadcasts music, sports, news and  
entertainment programming. A service fee is required in order to receive  
SIRIUS service. Vehicles that are equipped with a factory installed  
SIRIUS Satellite Radio system include:  
Hardware and limited subscription term, which begins on the date of  
sale or lease of the vehicle.  
Use of online media player providing access to all SIRIUS music  
channels over the internet using any computer connected to the  
internet (U.S. customers only)  
For information on extended subscription terms, contact SIRIUS at  
1–888–539–7474.  
Note: SIRIUS reserves the unrestricted right to change, rearrange, add  
or delete programming including canceling, moving or adding particular  
channels, and its prices, at any time, with or without notice to you. Ford  
Motor Company shall not be responsible for any such programming  
changes.  
Satellite Radio Electronic Serial Number (ESN): This 12-digit  
Satellite Serial Number is needed to activate, modify or track your  
satellite radio account. You will need this number when communicating  
with SIRIUS. While in Satellite Radio mode, you can view this number on  
the radio display by pressing the SIRIUS and Preset 1 buttons at the  
same time.  
33  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Radio Display  
Condition  
Action Required  
ACQUIRING  
Radio requires No action required. This message  
more than two  
seconds to  
should disappear shortly.  
produce audio  
for the selected  
channel.  
SAT FAULT  
Internal module  
If this message does not clear  
or system failure within a short period of time, or  
present.  
with an ignition key cycle, your  
receiver may have a fault. See  
your authorized dealer for service.  
This previously available channel  
is no longer available. Tune to  
another channel. If the channel  
was one of your presets, you may  
choose another channel for that  
preset button.  
INVALID CHNL  
Channel no  
longer available.  
UNSUBSCRIBED Subscription not  
Contact SIRIUS at  
available for this 1–888–539–7474 to subscribe to  
channel.  
the channel or tune to another  
channel.  
NO TEXT  
NO TEXT  
Artist  
information not  
available.  
Song title  
information not  
available.  
Artist information not available at  
this time on this channel. The  
system is working properly.  
Song title information not  
available at this time on this  
channel. The system is working  
properly.  
NO TEXT  
Category  
Category information not available  
information not at this time on this channel. The  
available. system is working properly.  
34  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Radio Display  
Condition  
Action Required  
NO SIGNAL  
Loss of signal  
You are in a location that is  
from the SIRIUS blocking the SIRIUS signal (i.e.,  
satellite or  
SIRIUS tower to  
the vehicle  
tunnel, under an overpass, dense  
foliage, etc). The system is  
working properly. When you move  
into an open area, the signal  
should return.  
antenna.  
UPDATING  
Update of  
channel  
No action required. The process  
may take up to three minutes.  
programming in  
progress.  
CALL SIRIUS  
Satellite service Call SIRIUS at 1–888–539–7474 to  
1–888–539–7474  
has been  
deactivated by  
SIRIUS Satellite  
Radio.  
re-activate or resolve subscription  
issues.  
SYNC (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with SYNC, a hands-free communications  
and entertainment system with special phone and media features. For  
more information, please refer to the SYNC supplement.  
35  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
MANUAL HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM  
1.  
Fan speed adjustment: Controls the volume of air circulated in  
the vehicle.  
R
2.  
Rear defroster: Press to activate/deactivate the rear window  
defroster. Refer to Rear window defroster later in this chapter for more  
information.  
3.  
Defrost: Distributes outside air through the windshield defroster  
vents and demister vents. Can be used to clear the windshield of fog and  
thin ice. The system will automatically provide outside air to reduce  
window fogging. Press this button again to return to the previous air flow  
selection.  
4.  
: Distributes air through the windshield defroster vents, demister  
vents, floor vents and rear seat floor vents. The system will automatically  
provide outside air to reduce window fogging.  
5.  
Power: Press to activate/deactivate the climate control system.  
When the system is off, outside air is prevented from entering the  
vehicle.  
6.  
7.  
: Distributes air through the instrument panel vents.  
: Distributes air through the instrument panel vents, floor vents,  
rear seat floor vents and demister vents.  
8. : Distributes air through the floor vents, rear seat floor vents and  
demister vents.  
36  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
9. Temperature control: Controls the temperature of the airflow in the  
vehicle.  
10.  
Passenger heated seat control (if equipped): Press to  
activate/deactivate the passenger heated seat. See Heated seats in the  
Seating and Safety Restraints chapter.  
11.  
Recirculated air: Press to activate/deactivate air recirculation  
in the vehicle. Recirculated air may reduce the amount of time needed to  
cool down the interior of the vehicle and may also help reduce undesired  
odors from reaching the interior of the vehicle. Recirculated air engages  
automatically when MAX A/C is selected or can be engaged manually in  
any airflow mode except  
(defrost). When the ignition switch is  
turned off and back on, the climate system will return to the recirculated  
air mode only if the A/C button LED is illuminated and the air  
distribution selection is either  
(panel) or  
(panel/floor).  
12. MAX A/C: Distributes recirculated air through the instrument panel  
vents to cool the vehicle. This re-cooling of the interior air is more  
economical and efficient. Recirculated air may also help reduce  
undesirable odors from entering the vehicle. Press the MAX A/C button  
again for normal A/C operation.  
13. A/C: Press to activate/deactivate air conditioning. Use with  
recirculated air to improve cooling performance and efficiency. A/C  
engages automatically in MAX A/C,  
(floor/defrost).  
(defrost) and  
14.  
Driver heated seat control (if equipped): Press to  
activate/deactivate the driver heated seat. See Heated seats in the  
Seating and Safety Restraints chapter.  
Operating tips  
To reduce fog build up on the windshield during humid weather,  
select  
(defrost) or  
(floor/defrost).  
To reduce humidity build up inside the vehicle, do not drive with the  
system off or with (recirculated air) engaged and A/C off.  
Do not put objects under the front seats that will interfere with the  
airflow to the back seats.  
Remove any snow, ice or leaves from the air intake area at the base of  
the windshield.  
To improve the time to reach comfort in hot weather, drive with the  
windows slightly open for 2-3 minutes after start up or until the  
vehicle has been “aired out.”  
37  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
During extreme high ambient temperatures when idling stationary for  
extended periods of time in gear, it is recommended to run the A/C in the  
MAX A/C position, reduce blower fan speed from the highest setting and  
put the vehicle’s transmission into the PARK gear position (automatic  
transmission only) to continue to receive cool air from your A/C system.  
For maximum cooling performance in MAX A/C mode:  
1. Select MAX A/C.  
2. Select the coolest temperature setting.  
3. Set the fan to the highest speed initially. As the interior starts to cool  
down, adjust the fan speed to maintain comfort.  
To aid in side window defogging/demisting in cold weather:  
1. Select  
.
2. Select A/C.  
3. Adjust the temperature control to maintain comfort.  
4. Set the fan speed to the highest setting.  
5. Direct the outer instrument panel vents towards the side windows.  
To increase airflow to the outer instrument panel vents, close the vents  
located in the middle of the instrument panel.  
R
REAR WINDOW DEFROSTER  
The rear defroster control is located on the climate control panel and  
works to clear the rear window of fog and thin ice.  
The engine must be running to operate the rear window defroster.  
R
Press  
to turn the rear window defroster on. An indicator light on the  
button will illuminate when active. The rear window defroster turns off  
automatically after a predetermined amount of time, if a low battery  
condition is detected or when the ignition is turned off or to the  
accessory position. To manually turn off the rear window defroster at any  
time, press the control again.  
If your vehicle is equipped with both rear defroster and heated mirrors,  
the same button will activate both. Refer to Heated outside mirrors in  
the Driver Controls chapter.  
Do not use razor blades or other sharp objects to clean the inside  
of the rear window or to remove decals from the inside or the  
rear window. This may cause damage to the heated grid lines and  
will not be covered by your warranty.  
38  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
HEADLAMP CONTROL  
Turns the lamps off.  
Turns on the parking lamps,  
instrument panel lamps, license  
plate lamps and tail lamps.  
Turns the low beam headlamps  
on.  
Fog lamp control (if equipped)  
The fog lamps can be turned on  
when the headlamp control is in  
the  
or  
position and the  
high beams are not turned on.  
Pull headlamp control towards you  
to turn fog lamps on. The fog lamp  
indicator light  
on the headlamp  
control will illuminate.  
High beams  
Push the lever toward the  
instrument panel to activate. Pull  
the lever towards you to deactivate.  
F
OF  
39  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Flash to pass  
Pull toward you slightly to activate  
and release to deactivate.  
Daytime running lamps (DRL) (if equipped)  
Turns the headlamps on with a reduced output.  
To activate:  
the ignition must be in the on position and  
the headlamp control is in the off or parking lamp position.  
WARNING: Always remember to turn on your headlamps at  
dusk or during inclement weather. The Daytime Running Lamp  
(DRL) system does not activate the tail lamps and generally may not  
provide adequate lighting during these conditions. Failure to activate  
your headlamps under these conditions may result in a collision.  
PANEL DIMMER CONTROL  
Use to adjust the brightness of the  
instrument panel and all applicable  
switches in the vehicle during  
headlamp and parking lamp  
operation.  
Move the control to the full upright  
position, past detent, to turn on the  
interior lamps.  
Note: If the battery is disconnected,  
discharged, or a new battery is  
installed, the dimmer switch requires re-calibration. Rotate the dimmer  
switch from the full dim position to the full dome/on position to reset.  
This will ensure that your displays are visible under all lighting  
conditions.  
40  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
AIMING THE HEADLAMPS  
The headlamps on your vehicle are properly aimed at the assembly plant.  
If your vehicle has been in an accident, the alignment of your headlamps  
should be checked by your authorized dealer.  
Vertical aim adjustment  
1. Park the vehicle directly in front of a wall or screen on a level surface,  
approximately 25 feet (7.6 meters) away.  
(1) 8 feet (2.4 meters)  
(2) Center height of lamp to  
ground  
(3) 25 feet (7.6 meters)  
(4) Horizontal reference line  
2. Measure the height from the  
center of your headlamp to the  
ground and mark an 8 foot  
(2.4 meter) horizontal reference line  
on the vertical wall or screen at this  
height (a piece of masking tape works well).  
3. Turn on the low beam headlamps to illuminate the wall or screen and  
open the hood.  
4. On the wall or screen you will  
observe an area of high intensity  
light. The top of the high intensity  
area should touch the horizontal  
reference line. If not, the beam will  
need to be adjusted.  
41  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
5. Locate the vertical adjuster on  
each headlamp, then use a 7 mm  
Allen wrench or a Phillips  
screwdriver to adjust the headlamp  
up or down.  
6. HORIZONTAL AIM IS NOT  
REQUIRED FOR THIS VEHICLE  
AND IS NON-ADJUSTABLE.  
7. Close the hood and turn off the  
lamps.  
TURN SIGNAL CONTROL  
Push down to activate the left  
turn signal.  
Push up to activate the right turn  
signal.  
INTERIOR LAMPS  
Map lamps  
To turn on the map lamps, press the  
outer edge of the clear lens. The  
map lamp lights when:  
any door is opened.  
the remote entry controls are  
pressed and the ignition is off.  
42  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Ambient lighting (if equipped)  
Illuminates four footwells and three  
cupholders with a choice of seven  
colors. The ambient lighting control  
switch is located on the instrument  
panel. To activate, press and release  
the control switch to cycle through  
the seven color choices plus the off  
state.  
The lights come on whenever the ignition is in either the on or accessory  
position.  
Note: The ambient lights will stay on until after the ignition is placed in  
the off position and either of the front doors are opened or the accessory  
delay timer expires.  
BULB REPLACEMENT  
Lamp assembly condensation  
Exterior lamps are vented to accommodate normal changes in pressure.  
Condensation can be a natural by-product of this design. When moist air  
enters the lamp assembly through the vents, there is a possibility that  
condensation can occur when the temperature is cold. When normal  
condensation occurs, a thin film of mist can form on the interior of the  
lens. The thin mist eventually clears and exits through the vents during  
normal operation. Clearing time may take as long as 48 hours under dry  
weather conditions.  
Examples of acceptable condensation are:  
Presence of thin mist (no streaks, drip marks or droplets)  
Fine mist covers less than 50% of the lens  
Examples of unacceptable moisture (usually caused by a lamp water  
leak) are:  
Water puddle inside the lamp  
Large water droplets, drip marks or streaks present on the interior of  
the lens  
Take your vehicle to dealer for service if any of the above conditions of  
unacceptable moisture are present.  
43  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Using the right bulbs  
Replacement bulbs are specified in the chart below. Headlamp bulbs  
must be marked with an authorized “D.O.T.” for North America to ensure  
lamp performance, light brightness and pattern and safe visibility. The  
correct bulbs will not damage the lamp assembly or void the lamp  
assembly warranty and will provide quality bulb burn time.  
Function  
Trade number  
Headlamps  
H13  
Park and turn lamp (front)  
Side marker lamp (front)  
Fog lamps (if equipped)  
Stop/turn and tail lamps  
Backup lamp  
3457 NAK or 3457AK  
168  
H11 LL  
3057K  
921  
License plate lamp  
* High-mount brake lamp  
C5W L  
LED  
* To replace these lamps - see your authorized dealer.  
To replace all instrument panel lights - see your authorized dealer  
Replacing interior bulbs  
Check the operation of all bulbs frequently.  
Replacing exterior bulbs  
Check the operation of all the bulbs frequently.  
Replacing headlamp bulbs  
1. Make sure the headlamp control  
is in the off position and open the  
hood.  
2. Remove four push pins from the  
radiator grille and pull the grille  
forward to access the lower screw.  
3. Remove three bolts and washers  
from the headlamp assembly.  
4. Carefully pull the headlamp  
assembly up and away from the  
vehicle to disengage the spring clip located on the bottom of the  
headlamp assembly.  
5. Disconnect electrical connector from the bulb.  
44  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
6. Remove bulb from the headlamp  
assembly by turning it  
counterclockwise, then pull it  
straight out.  
Install the new bulb in reverse  
order.  
WARNING: Handle a halogen headlamp bulb carefully and keep  
out of children’s reach. Grasp the bulb by only its plastic base  
and do not touch the glass. The oil from your hand could cause the  
bulb to break the next time the headlamps are operated.  
Note: If the bulb is accidentally touched, it should be cleaned with  
rubbing alcohol before being used.  
Replacing front parking lamp/turn signal bulbs  
1. Make sure the headlamp control  
is in the off position and open the  
hood.  
2. Remove four push pins from the  
radiator grille and pull the grille  
forward to access the lower screw.  
3. Remove three bolts and washers  
from the headlamp assembly.  
4. Carefully pull the headlamp  
assembly up and away from the  
vehicle to disengage the spring clip located on the bottom of the  
headlamp assembly.  
5. Remove the bulb socket from the  
lamp assembly by turning  
counterclockwise.  
6. Pull the bulb straight out of the  
socket.  
Install the new bulb in reverse  
order.  
45  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
Replacing side marker bulbs  
1. Make sure the headlamp control  
is in the off position and open the  
hood.  
2. Remove four push pins from the  
radiator grille and pull the grille  
forward to access the lower screw.  
3. Remove three bolts and washers  
from the headlamp assembly.  
4. Carefully pull the headlamp  
assembly up and away from the  
vehicle to disengage the spring clip located on the bottom of the  
headlamp assembly.  
5. Remove the bulb socket from the  
lamp assembly by turning  
counterclockwise.  
6. Pull the bulb straight out of the  
socket.  
Install the new bulb in reverse  
order.  
Replacing tail/brake/backup lights and turn signal bulbs  
1. Make sure the headlamp control  
is in the off position and then open  
the trunk.  
2. Remove two plastic screws and  
cover from inside the luggage  
compartment.  
3. Remove two nuts from the lamp  
assembly.  
4. Gently pull the lamp assembly away from the vehicle.  
5. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise and pull it out.  
6. Pull the bulb straight out of the socket.  
Install the new bulb in reverse order.  
46  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
Replacing fog lamp bulbs (if equipped)  
1. Make sure the headlamp switch is  
in the off position.  
2. Reach under the front fender, and  
remove the harness/bulb assembly  
from the fog lamp by turning  
counterclockwise.  
3. Disconnect the harness from the  
bulb by pulling it straight off.  
Install the new bulb in reverse order.  
Replacing license plate lamp bulbs  
1. Make sure the headlamp switch is  
in the off position.  
2. Remove the two screws and the  
lens from the license plate lamp  
assembly.  
3. Carefully pull the bulb straight  
out from the lamp assembly.  
Install new bulb(s) in reverse order.  
Replacing high-mount brake lamp assembly  
Your vehicle is equipped with an LED center high-mount stop lamp. It is  
designed to last the life of the vehicle. If replacement is required, it is  
recommended that you see your authorized dealer.  
47  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
MULTI-FUNCTION LEVER  
Windshield wiper: Rotate the end  
of the control away from you to  
increase the speed of the wipers;  
rotate towards you to decrease the  
speed of the wipers.  
Windshield washer: Push the end  
of the stalk:  
briefly: causes a single swipe of  
the wipers without washer fluid.  
a quick push and hold: the wipers  
will swipe three times with  
washer fluid.  
a long push and hold: the wipers  
and washer fluid will be activated  
for up to ten seconds.  
Courtesy wipe feature: One extra wipe will happen a few seconds  
after washing the front window to clear any water that is dripping down  
from the top of the windshield caused by the washing.  
Note: Do not operate the washer when the washer reservoir is empty.  
This may cause the washer pump to overheat. Check the washer fluid  
level frequently. Do not operate the wipers when the windshield is dry.  
This may scratch the glass, damage the wiper blades and cause the wiper  
motor to burn out. Before operating the wiper on a dry windshield,  
always use the windshield washer. In freezing weather, be sure the wiper  
blades are not frozen to the windshield before operating the wipers.  
48  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
TILT STEERING WHEEL  
To adjust the steering wheel:  
1. Pull the lever down to unlock the  
steering column.  
2. While the lever is in the down  
position, move the steering wheel  
up or down until you find the  
desired position.  
3. While holding the steering wheel  
in place, pull the lever up to its  
original position to lock the steering  
column.  
WARNING: Never adjust the steering wheel when the vehicle is  
moving.  
ELECTRONIC COMPASS (IF EQUIPPED)  
The compass heading is displayed as one of N, NE, E, SE, S, SW, W and  
NW in the center stack display.  
The compass reading may be affected when you drive near large  
buildings, bridges, power lines and powerful broadcast antenna. Magnetic  
or metallic objects placed in, on or near the vehicle may also affect  
compass accuracy.  
Usually, when something affects the compass readings, the compass will  
correct itself after a few days of operating your vehicle in normal  
conditions. If the compass still appears to be inaccurate, a manual  
calibration may be necessary. Refer to Compass zone adjustment.  
Most geographic areas (zones) have a magnetic north compass point that  
varies slightly from the northerly direction on maps. This variation is four  
degrees between adjacent zones and will become noticeable as the  
vehicle crosses multiple zones. A correct zone setting will eliminate this  
error. Refer to Compass calibration adjustment.  
49  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Compass zone adjustment  
1. Determine which magnetic zone  
you are in for your geographic  
location by referring to the zone  
map.  
3 2  
4
1
15  
14  
13  
2. Turn ignition to the on position.  
5
12  
6
7 8 91011  
3. Press and hold the 7 and 9 radio  
preset buttons together for  
approximately five seconds until  
ZONE XX appears in the CID.  
4. Press and release the 7 and 9  
radio preset buttons together,  
repeatedly until ZONE XX changes  
to the correct zone (1–15) in the  
CID.  
5. The direction will display after  
the buttons are released. The zone  
is now updated.  
Compass calibration adjustment  
Perform compass calibration in an open area free from steel structures  
and high voltage lines. For optimum calibration, turn off all electrical  
accessories (heater/air conditioning, wipers, etc.) and make sure all  
vehicle doors are shut.  
1. Start the vehicle.  
50  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
2. To calibrate, press and hold the 7  
and 9 radio preset buttons together  
for approximately 10 seconds until  
CAL appears. Release the buttons.  
3. Slowly drive the vehicle in a  
circle (less than 3 mph [5 km/h])  
until the CAL display changes to the  
direction value (N, S, E, W, etc.). It  
may take up to five circles to  
complete calibration.  
4. The compass is now calibrated.  
CENTER CONSOLE  
Your vehicle has a variety of console features. These include:  
Cupholders  
Utility compartment  
WARNING: Use only soft cups in the cupholder. Hard objects  
can injure you in a collision.  
AUXILIARY POWER POINT (12VDC)  
Power outlet is designed for accessory plugs only. Do not insert  
any other object in the power outlet as this will damage the  
outlet and blow the fuse. Do not hang any type of accessory or  
accessory bracket from the plug. Improper use of the power  
outlet can cause damage not covered by your warranty.  
The auxiliary power points are  
located on the instrument panel.  
Do not use the power point for  
operating the cigarette lighter  
element (if equipped).  
To prevent the fuse from being blown, do not use the power point(s)  
over the vehicle capacity of 12 VDC/180W. If the power point or cigar  
lighter socket is not working, a fuse may have blown. Refer to Fuses and  
relays in the Roadside Emergencies chapter for information on  
checking and replacing fuses.  
51  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
To have full capacity usage of your power point, the engine is required to  
be running to avoid unintentional discharge of the battery. To prevent  
the battery from being discharged:  
do not use the power point longer than necessary when the engine is  
not running,  
do not leave battery chargers, video game adapters, computers and  
other devices plugged in overnight or when the vehicle is parked for  
extended periods.  
Always keep the power point caps closed when not being used.  
Cigar lighter (if equipped)  
Do not plug optional electrical accessories into the cigarette lighter  
socket.  
Do not hold the lighter in with your hand while it is heating, this will  
damage the lighter element and socket. The lighter will be released from  
its heating position when it is ready to be used.  
Note: Improper use of the lighter can cause damage not covered by your  
warranty, and can result in fire or serious injury.  
POWER WINDOWS  
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle and  
do not let children play with the power windows. They may  
seriously injure themselves.  
WARNING: When closing the power windows, you should verify  
they are free of obstructions and ensure that children and/or  
pets are not in the proximity of the window openings.  
Press and pull the window switches  
to open and close windows.  
Push down (to the first detent)  
and hold the switch to open.  
Pull up (to the first detent) and  
hold the switch to close.  
52  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
One touch down (AUTO)  
Allows the driver’s window to open  
fully without holding the control  
down. Push the switch completely  
down to the second detent and  
release quickly. The window will  
open fully. Momentarily press the  
switch to any position to stop the  
window operation.  
Window lock (if equipped)  
The window lock feature allows only  
the driver to operate the power  
windows.  
To lock out all the window controls  
(except for the driver’s) press the  
right side of the control. Press the  
left side to restore the window  
controls.  
INTERIOR MIRROR  
The interior rear view mirror has two pivot points on the support arm  
which lets you adjust the mirror UP or DOWN and from SIDE to SIDE.  
WARNING: Do not adjust the mirror while the vehicle is in  
motion.  
Automatic dimming interior rear view mirror (if equipped)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with  
an interior rear view mirror which  
has an auto-dimming function. The  
electronic day/night mirror will  
change from the normal (high  
reflective) state to the non-glare  
(darkened) state when bright lights  
(glare) reach the mirror. When the mirror detects bright light from  
behind the vehicle, it will automatically adjust (darken) to minimize  
glare.  
The mirror will automatically return to the normal state whenever the  
vehicle is placed in R (Reverse) to ensure a bright clear view when  
backing up.  
53  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Do not block the sensors on the front and back of the interior  
rear view mirror since this may impair proper mirror  
performance.  
Do not clean the housing or glass of any mirror with harsh  
abrasives, fuel or other petroleum-based cleaning products.  
EXTERIOR MIRRORS  
Power side view mirrors (if equipped)  
WARNING: Do not adjust the mirror while the vehicle is in  
motion.  
To adjust your mirrors:  
1. Rotate the control clockwise to  
adjust the right mirror and rotate  
the control counterclockwise to  
adjust the left mirror.  
2. Move the control in the direction  
you wish to tilt the mirror.  
3. Return to the center position to lock mirrors in place.  
Heated outside mirrors (if equipped)  
Both mirrors are heated  
automatically to remove ice, mist  
and fog when the rear window  
defrost is activated.  
Do not remove ice from the  
mirrors with a scraper or  
attempt to readjust the mirror  
glass if it is frozen in place.  
These actions could cause damage to the glass and mirrors.  
Do not clean the housing or glass of any mirror with harsh  
abrasives, fuel or other petroleum-based cleaning products.  
SPEED CONTROL (IF EQUIPPED)  
With speed control set, you can maintain a set speed without keeping  
your foot on the accelerator pedal.  
54  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
WARNING: Do not use the speed control in heavy traffic or on  
roads that are winding, slippery or unpaved.  
Setting speed control  
The controls for using your speed  
control are located on the steering  
wheel for your convenience.  
1. Press the ON control and release  
it.  
2. Accelerate to the desired speed.  
3. Press the SET + control and  
release it.  
4. Take your foot off the accelerator  
pedal.  
5. The indicator light  
on the  
instrument cluster will turn on.  
Note:  
Vehicle speed may vary momentarily when driving up and down a  
steep hill.  
If the vehicle speed increases above the set speed on a downhill, you  
may want to apply the brakes to reduce the speed.  
If the vehicle speed decreases more than 10 mph (16 km/h) below  
your set speed on an uphill, your speed control will disengage.  
Disengaging speed control  
To disengage the speed control:  
Depress the brake pedal or  
Depress the clutch pedal (if equipped).  
Disengaging the speed control will not erase previous set speed.  
55  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Note: When you use the clutch pedal to disengage the speed control,  
the engine speed may briefly increase, this is normal.  
Resuming a set speed  
Press the RESUME control and  
release it. This will automatically  
return the vehicle to the previously  
set speed.  
Increasing speed while using speed control  
There are three ways to set a higher  
speed:  
Press and hold the SET + control  
until you get to the desired  
speed, then release the control.  
Press and release the SET +  
control to operate the Tap-Up  
function. Each tap will increase  
the set speed by 1 mph  
(1.6 km/h).  
Use the accelerator pedal to get to the desired speed. When the  
vehicle reaches that speed, press and release the SET + control.  
Reducing speed while using speed control  
There are three ways to reduce a  
set speed:  
Press and hold the SET - control  
until you get to the desired  
speed, then release the control.  
Press and release the SET -  
control to operate the Tap-Down  
function. Each tap will decrease  
the set speed by 1 mph  
(1.6 km/h).  
56  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Depress the brake pedal until the  
desired vehicle speed is reached,  
press the SET + control.  
Turning off speed control  
There are two ways to turn off the  
speed control:  
Press the speed control OFF  
control.  
Turn off the ignition.  
Note: When you turn off the speed  
control or the ignition, your speed  
control set speed memory is erased.  
STEERING WHEEL CONTROLS (IF EQUIPPED)  
Radio control features  
Press MEDIA to select:  
AM, FM1, FM2, or CD  
SAT1, SAT2 or SAT3 (Satellite  
Radio mode if equipped).  
LINE IN (Auxiliary input jack) (if  
equipped)  
57  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
In AM, FM1, or FM2 mode:  
Press  
to access the  
next/previous preset station.  
In Satellite radio mode (if  
equipped):  
Press  
to advance  
through preset channels.  
In CD mode:  
Press  
to listen to the next track on the disc.  
In any mode:  
Press VOL + or VOL - to adjust  
the volume.  
SYNC hands free control feature  
(if equipped)  
Press  
briefly to use the voice  
command feature. You will hear a  
tone and LISTENING will appear in  
the radio display. Press and  
hold  
to exit voice command.  
Press  
to activate phone mode or  
answer a phone call. Press and  
hold  
to end call or exit phone  
mode.  
Press  
to scroll through various menus and selections. Press  
OK to confirm your selection.  
For further information on the SYNC system, refer to the SYNC  
supplement.  
58  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
MOON ROOF (SUNROOF) (IF EQUIPPED)  
You can move the glass panel of the moon roof back to open or tilt up to  
ventilate the vehicle.  
WARNING: Do not let children play with the moon roof or leave  
children unattended in the vehicle. They may seriously hurt  
themselves.  
The moon roof is equipped with an automatic, one-touch, express  
opening and closing feature. To stop motion at any time during the  
one-touch operation, press the control a second time.  
Note: The moon roof will open to the “comfort” position first before  
opening all the way. The “comfort” position helps to alleviate rumbling  
wind noise which may happen in the vehicle with the roof fully opened.  
To open the moon roof: Press and  
release the SLIDE control. The  
moon roof will open to the  
“comfort” position. Press and release  
the control again to fully open.  
Press the switch again to stop the  
moon roof.  
WARNING: When closing the moon roof, you should verify that  
it is free of obstructions and ensure that children and/or pets are  
not in the proximity of the moon roof opening.  
To close the moon roof: Pull and release the SLIDE control, the moon  
roof will close automatically. Press the switch again to stop the moon  
roof.  
Bounce-back: When an obstacle has been detected in the moon roof  
opening as the moon roof is closing, the moon roof will automatically  
open and stop at a prescribed position.  
Bounce-back override: To override bounce-back function, pull and hold  
the SLIDE switch within two seconds of a bounce-back event. The  
closing force will begin to increase each time the moon roof is closed for  
the first three closing cycles, with bounce-back active. For example:  
Bounce-back can be used to overcome the resistance of ice on the moon  
roof or seals  
59  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
To vent the moon roof: Press and release the TILT control, the moon  
roof will move to the vent position automatically from any moon roof  
position. Press the switch again to stop the moon roof. Pull and hold the  
TILT control to close the moon roof.  
The moon roof has a built-in sliding shade that can be manually opened  
or closed when the glass panel is shut. To close the shade, pull it toward  
the front of the vehicle.  
Relearning function: In case the moon roof does not close properly  
anymore, follow this relearning procedure.  
Tilt the moon roof into the vent position as far as possible. Release the  
switch.  
Press and hold the same switch again for 30 seconds until you see the  
moon roof move.  
Release the switch and immediately press and hold it again. The moon  
roof will close, open fully and then close again. Do not release the  
switch before the moon roof has reached the closed position for the  
second time.  
Safety mode: If the system detects a malfunction, it enters a safety  
mode. The moon roof will move about 0.5 seconds at a time and then  
stop again. Press the switch repeatedly until the moon roof is closed.  
Have the system checked by your authorized dealer immediately.  
MESSAGE CENTER (IF EQUIPPED)  
With the ignition in the on position,  
the message center, located on your  
instrument cluster, displays  
important vehicle information  
through a constant monitor of  
vehicle systems. You may select  
display features on the message center for a display of status. The  
system will also notify you of potential vehicle problems with a display of  
system warnings followed by a long indicator chime.  
60  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Selectable features  
Reset  
Press this control to select and reset  
functions shown in the INFO menu  
and SETUP menu.  
Info menu  
This control displays the following  
control displays:  
Odometer/Trip Odometer A or B  
Distance to Empty  
Average Fuel Economy  
Instantaneous Fuel Economy  
Blank (odometer off)  
Odometer/Trip odometer  
Refer to Gauges in the Instrument Cluster chapter.  
Distance to empty (DTE)  
Selecting this function from the  
INFO menu will give you an  
estimate of how far you can drive  
with the fuel remaining in your tank  
under normal driving conditions.  
Remember to turn the ignition off  
when refueling your vehicle. Otherwise, the display will not show the  
addition of fuel for a few miles (kilometers). DTE will vary according to  
your driving habits.  
Average fuel economy (AFE)  
Select this function from the INFO  
menu to display your average fuel  
economy in miles/gallon or  
liters/100 km.  
61  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
If you calculate your average fuel economy by dividing miles traveled by  
gallons of fuel used (liters of fuel by used 100 kilometers traveled), your  
figure may be different than displayed for the following reasons:  
your vehicle was not perfectly level during fill-up  
differences in the automatic shut-off points on the fuel pumps at  
service stations  
variations in top-off procedure from one fill-up to another  
rounding off the displayed values to the nearest 0.1 gallon (liter)  
1. Drive the vehicle at least 5 miles (8 km) with the speed control  
system engaged to display a stabilized average.  
2. Record the highway fuel economy for future reference.  
It is important to press the RESET control after setting the speed  
control to get accurate highway fuel economy readings.  
Instantaneous fuel economy  
Select this function from the INFO  
menu to display your instantaneous  
fuel economy. This will display your  
fuel economy as a bar graph ranging  
from  
poor economy to  
excellent economy.  
Your vehicle must be moving to calculate instantaneous fuel economy.  
When your vehicle is not moving, this function shows  
illuminated. Instantaneous fuel economy cannot be reset.  
, one or no bars  
Setup menu  
Press this control for the following  
displays:  
Reset to English (if in another  
language)  
System Check  
Units (English/Metric)  
Autolock (if equipped)  
Autounlock (if equipped)  
Language  
62  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Reset to English (if in another language)  
When entering the SETUP MENU  
and a non-English language has  
been selected, “HOLD RESET FOR  
ENGLISH” will be displayed to  
change back to English.  
Hold the RESET control to change back to English.  
System check  
Selecting this function from the  
SETUP menu causes the message  
center to cycle through each of the  
systems being monitored. For each  
of the monitored systems, the  
message center will indicate either  
an OK message or a warning message for three seconds.  
Pressing the RESET control cycles the message center through each of  
the systems being monitored.  
The sequence of the system check report is as follows:  
1. CHARGING SYSTEM  
2. DOORS  
3. TRUNK  
4. BRAKE SYSTEM  
5. DTE/FUEL LEVEL  
Units (English/Metric)  
1. Select this function from the  
SETUP menu for the current units  
to be displayed.  
2. Press the RESET control to  
change from English to Metric.  
Autolock  
This feature automatically locks all vehicle doors when the vehicle is  
shifted into any gear, putting the vehicle in motion.  
63  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
1. To disable/enable the autolock  
feature, select this function from the  
SETUP control for the current  
display mode.  
2. Press the RESET control to turn  
the autolock ON or OFF.  
Autounlock  
This feature automatically unlocks all vehicle doors when the driver’s  
door is opened within 10 minutes of the ignition being turned off.  
1. To disable/enable the autounlock  
feature, select this function from the  
SETUP control for the current  
display mode.  
2. Press the RESET control switch  
to turn the autounlock ON or OFF.  
Language  
1. Select this function from the  
SETUP menu for the current  
language to be displayed.  
2. Waiting four seconds or pressing  
the RESET control cycles the  
message center through each of the language choices.  
Selectable languages are English, Spanish, or French.  
3. Press and hold the RESET control for two seconds to set the language  
choice.  
System warnings  
System warnings alert you to possible problems or malfunctions in your  
vehicle’s operating systems.  
In the event of a multiple warning situation, the message center will  
cycle the display to show all warnings by displaying each one for four  
seconds.  
The message center will display the last selected feature if there are no  
more warning messages. This allows you to use the full functionality of  
the message center after you acknowledge the warning by pressing the  
RESET control and clearing the warning message.  
64  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Warning messages that have been reset are divided into two categories:  
They will reappear on the display 10 minutes from the reset.  
They will not reappear until an ignition off-on cycle has been  
completed.  
This acts as a reminder that these warning conditions still exist within  
the vehicle.  
Warnings  
Status  
Driver door ajar  
Warning cannot be reset  
Passenger door ajar  
Rear left door ajar  
(if equipped)  
Rear right door ajar  
(if equipped)  
Park brake engaged  
XXX miles to E fuel level low  
Check brake system  
Brake fluid level low  
Low tire pressure  
Tire pressure monitor fault  
Tire pressure sensor fault  
Warning returns after 10 minutes if  
condition still exists  
Warning returns after the ignition key  
is turned from off to on.  
DRIVER DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the driver door is not  
completely closed.  
PASSENGER DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the passenger door is  
not completely closed.  
REAR LEFT DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the rear left door is not  
completely closed.  
REAR RIGHT DOOR AJAR — Displayed when the rear right door is  
not completely closed.  
PARK BRAKE ENGAGED — Displayed when the manual park brake is  
set. If the warning stays on after the park brake is released, contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
XXX MILES TO E FUEL LEVEL LOW — Displayed as an early  
reminder of a low fuel condition.  
CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM — Displayed when the braking system is not  
operating properly. If the warning stays on or continues to come on,  
contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
65  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL LOW — Indicates the brake fluid level is low  
and the brake system should be inspected immediately. Refer to  
Brake/clutch fluid in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
LOW TIRE PRESSURE — Displayed when one or more tires on your  
vehicle have low tire pressure. Refer to Inflating your tires in the Tires,  
Wheels and Loading chapter.  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT — Displayed when the Tire  
Pressure Monitoring System is malfunctioning. If the warning stays on or  
continues to come on, contact your authorized dealer as soon as  
possible.  
TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT — Displayed when a tire pressure  
sensor is malfunctioning, or your spare tire is in use. For more  
information on how the system operates under these conditions, refer to  
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) in the Tires, Wheels and  
Loading chapter. If the warning stays on or continues to come on,  
contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
REMOTE LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT RELEASE (IF EQUIPPED)  
To open the luggage compartment,  
press the control on the instrument  
panel located to the left of the  
cluster.  
The control does not function if the  
vehicle is traveling faster then  
4 mph (7 km/h).  
66  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
POSITIVE RETENTION FLOOR MAT  
WARNING: Do not install additional floor mats on top of the  
factory installed floor mats as they may interfere with the  
accelerator or the brake pedals.  
Position the floor mat so the eyelet  
is over the pointed end of the  
retention post and then pull eyelet  
over and push floor mat down over  
retention post. Properly align mat in  
drivers footwell, rotating if  
necessary. Make sure the mat does  
not interfere with the operation of  
the accelerator, brake pedal or  
clutch pedal (if equipped). To  
remove the floor mat, reverse the  
installation procedure.  
67  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
KEYS  
One key operates all the locks and starts the vehicle. Always carry a  
spare key with you in case of an emergency.  
Your keys are programmed to your vehicle; using a non-programmed key  
will not permit your vehicle to start. If you lose your authorized dealer  
supplied keys, replacement keys are available through your authorized  
dealer. Refer to the SecuriLock™ passive anti-theft system section  
later in this chapter for more information.  
POWER DOOR LOCKS  
Press the  
control to unlock all  
doors.  
Press the  
control to lock all  
doors.  
Smart locks  
This feature helps to prevent you from locking yourself out of the vehicle  
if your key is still in the ignition.  
When you open one of the front doors and you lock the vehicle with the  
power door lock control (on the driver or passenger door trim panel), all  
the doors will lock, then all doors will automatically unlock reminding  
you that your key is still in the ignition.  
The vehicle can still be locked, with the key in the ignition, by locking  
the driver’s door with a key or using the lock control on the remote  
entry key fob.  
If both front doors are closed, the vehicle can be locked from any  
method, regardless of whether the key is in the ignition or not.  
Autolock (if equipped)  
The autolock feature will lock all the doors when:  
all doors are closed,  
the ignition is in the on position,  
you shift into any gear putting the vehicle in motion, and  
the vehicle attains a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h).  
68  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
The autolock feature repeats when:  
any door is opened then closed while the ignition is in the on position  
and the vehicle speed is 9 mph (15 km/h) or lower, and  
the vehicle attains a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h).  
Deactivating/activating autolock  
Your vehicle comes with the autolock feature enabled. There are three  
methods to enable/disable this feature:  
Through your authorized dealer, or  
Performing the power door lock control procedure, or  
Performing the message center (if equipped) procedure. Refer to  
Message center in the Driver Controls chapter.  
Note: The autolock feature can be activated/deactivated independently  
of the autounlock feature.  
Before following the activation or deactivation procedures, make sure  
that the anti-theft system is not armed, ignition is in the off position, and  
all vehicle doors are closed.  
69  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
Power door unlock/lock procedure  
Before starting, ensure the ignition is in the off position and all vehicle  
doors are closed. You must complete Steps 1–5 within 30 seconds or the  
procedure will have to be repeated. If the procedure needs to be  
repeated, wait a minimum of 30 seconds before beginning again.  
1. Place the key in the ignition and  
turn the ignition to the on position.  
2. Press the power door  
control  
on the door panel three times.  
3. Turn the ignition from the on  
position to the off position.  
4. Press the power door  
control  
on the door panel three times.  
5. Turn the ignition back to the on position. The horn will chirp one time  
to confirm programming mode has been entered and is active.  
6. To enable/disable the autolock feature, press the unlock control, then  
press the lock control. The horn will chirp once if autolock was  
deactivated or twice (one short and one long chirp) if autolock was  
activated.  
7. Turn the ignition to the off position. The horn will chirp once to  
confirm the procedure is complete.  
Autounlock feature (if equipped)  
The autounlock feature will unlock all the doors when:  
the ignition is in the on position, all the doors are closed, and the  
vehicle has been in motion at a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h);  
the vehicle has then come to a stop and the ignition is turned to the  
off or accessory position; and  
the driver door is opened within 10 minutes of the ignition being  
transitioned to the off or accessory position.  
Note: The doors will not autounlock if the vehicle has been  
electronically locked before the driver door is opened.  
70  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
Deactivating/activating autounlock feature  
Your vehicle comes with the autounlock features activated; there are  
three methods to enable/disable this feature:  
Through your authorized dealer,  
by using a power door unlock/lock sequence  
or by using the instrument cluster message center. Refer to Message  
center in the Driver Controls chapter.  
Note: The autounlock feature can be activated/deactivated  
independently of the autolock feature.  
Power door lock switch autounlock enable/disable procedure  
Before starting, ensure the ignition is in the off position and all vehicle  
doors are closed. You must complete Steps 1–5 within 30 seconds or the  
procedure will have to be repeated. If the procedure needs to be  
repeated, wait a minimum of 30 seconds before beginning again.  
1. Place the key in the ignition and  
turn the ignition to the on position.  
2. Press the power door  
control  
on the door panel three times.  
3. Turn the ignition from the on  
position to the off position.  
4. Press the power door  
control  
on the door panel three times.  
5. Turn the ignition back to the on position. The horn will chirp one time  
to confirm programming mode has been entered and is active.  
6. To enable/disable the autounlock feature, press the lock control, then  
press the unlock control. The horn will chirp once if autounlock was  
deactivated or twice (one short and one long chirp) if autounlock was  
activated.  
7. Turn the ignition to the off position. The horn will chirp once to  
confirm the procedure is complete.  
71  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
CHILDPROOF DOOR LOCKS  
When these locks are set, the  
rear doors cannot be opened from  
the inside.  
The rear doors can be opened  
from the outside when the doors  
are unlocked.  
The childproof locks are located on  
rear edge of each rear door and  
must be set separately for each  
door. Setting the lock for one door  
will not automatically set the lock  
for both doors.  
Insert the key and turn to the  
lock position (key horizontal) to  
engage the childproof locks.  
Insert the key and turn to the  
unlock position (key vertical) to  
disengage the childproof locks.  
INTERIOR LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT RELEASE  
Your vehicle is equipped with a mechanical interior luggage compartment  
release handle that provides a means of escape for children and adults in  
the event they become locked inside the luggage compartment.  
Adults are advised to familiarize themselves with the operation and  
location of the release handle.  
72  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
To open the luggage compartment  
door (lid) from within the luggage  
compartment, pull the illuminated  
“T” shaped handle and push up on  
the trunk lid. The handle is  
composed of a material that will  
glow for hours in darkness following  
brief exposure to ambient light.  
The “T” shaped handle will be  
located either on the luggage  
compartment door (lid) or inside  
the luggage compartment near the  
tail lamps.  
WARNING: Keep vehicle  
doors and luggage  
compartment locked and keep  
keys and remote transmitters out  
of a child’s reach. Unsupervised  
children could lock themselves in  
the trunk and risk injury. Children  
should be taught not to play in  
vehicles.  
WARNING: Do not leave children, unreliable adults, or animals  
unattended in the vehicle. On hot days, the temperature in the  
trunk or vehicle interior can rise very quickly. Exposure of people or  
animals to these high temperatures for even a short time can cause  
death or serious heat-related injuries, including brain damage. Small  
children are particularly at risk.  
73  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
REMOTE ENTRY SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC rules and with RSS-210 of  
Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) This device  
must accept any interference received, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation.  
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to  
operate the equipment.  
The typical operating range for your remote entry transmitter is  
approximately 33 feet (10 meters). A decrease in operating range could  
be caused by:  
weather conditions,  
nearby radio towers,  
structures around the vehicle, or  
other vehicles parked next to your vehicle.  
Your vehicle may have an all-door remote entry system.  
The all-door remote entry system  
allows you to:  
lock or unlock all vehicle doors  
without a key.  
open the luggage compartment  
without a key.  
activate the panic alarm.  
The remote entry lock/unlock  
feature operates in any ignition  
position except start. The panic feature operates with the key in the off  
position.  
If there are problems with the remote entry system, make sure to take  
ALL remote entry transmitters with you to the authorized dealer in  
order to aid in troubleshooting the problem.  
Unlocking the doors  
1. Press  
and release to unlock the driver’s door. Note: The interior  
lamps will illuminate.  
2. With the all-door remote entry, press  
three seconds to unlock all the doors.  
and release again within  
74  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
The remote entry system activates the illuminated entry feature. This  
feature turns on the interior lamps for 25 seconds or until the ignition is  
turned to the on position. The dome lamp control must be set to the ON  
position in order for the illuminated entry feature to operate.  
Programming unlocking mode (if equipped)  
The unlocking mode (if equipped) on the remote entry transmitter can  
be programmed. To change the unlocking mode from the single-door  
unlocking mode to the central all-door unlocking mode:  
With the vehicle in the off position, press the  
and  
on the  
remote entry transmitter simultaneously and hold for four seconds.  
The park/turn lamps will flash twice to indicate the mode change.  
Press the  
and  
on the remote entry transmitter simultaneously  
and hold for four seconds to toggle between unlocking modes.  
Locking the doors  
Press  
and release to lock all doors. Note: The park/turn lamps will  
flash once. If any door or trunk is ajar, the lamps will not flash. Once  
the door that was ajar is closed, the lamps will flash to indicate that  
the vehicle is locked and all doors are closed.  
Press  
and release a second time to confirm all doors have locked.  
Note: The horn will honk once and the park/turn lamps will flash if all  
doors are closed. The horn will honk twice if any door is ajar.  
Car finder  
Press  
twice within three seconds. The horn will chirp and the turn  
lamps will flash. It is recommended that this method be used to locate  
your vehicle, rather than using the panic alarm.  
Sounding a panic alarm  
Press  
to activate the alarm. Press again or turn the ignition to the on  
or accessory position to deactivate, or wait for the alarm to time out in  
three minutes.  
Note: The panic alarm will only operate when the ignition is in the off  
position.  
75  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Opening the luggage compartment  
Press  
once to open the luggage compartment. Note: This feature  
will only operate with the ignition in the off or the accessory position.  
Ensure that the trunk is closed and latched before driving your  
vehicle. Failure to properly latch the trunk may cause objects to fall  
out or block the driver’s rear view.  
Replacing the battery  
The remote entry transmitter uses one coin type three-volt lithium  
battery CR2032 or equivalent.  
To replace the battery:  
1. Twist a thin coin between the two  
halves of the remote entry  
transmitter near the key ring. DO  
NOT TAKE THE RUBBER COVER  
AND CIRCUIT BOARD OFF THE  
FRONT HOUSING OF THE  
REMOTE ENTRY TRANSMITTER.  
2. Do not wipe off any grease on the  
battery terminals on the back  
surface of the circuit board.  
3. Remove the old battery.  
Note: Please refer to local  
regulations when disposing of  
transmitter batteries.  
4. Insert the new battery. Refer to  
the diagram inside the remote entry  
transmitter for the correct  
orientation of the battery. Press the battery down to ensure that the  
battery is fully seated in the battery housing cavity.  
5. Snap the two halves back together.  
Note: Replacement of the battery will not cause the remote transmitter  
to become deprogrammed from your vehicle. The remote transmitter  
should operate normally after battery replacement.  
76  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Replacing lost remote entry transmitters  
If you would like to have your remote entry transmitter reprogrammed  
because you lost one, or would like to buy additional remote entry  
transmitters, you can either reprogram them yourself, or take all  
remote entry transmitters to your authorized dealer for  
reprogramming.  
How to reprogram your remote entry transmitters  
You must have all remote entry transmitters (maximum of four)  
available before beginning this procedure. If all remote entry transmitters  
are not present during the programming procedure, the transmitters that  
are not present during programming will no longer operate the vehicle.  
Note: Ensure the brake pedal is not depressed during this sequence.  
To reprogram the remote entry transmitters:  
1. Ensure the vehicle is electronically unlocked.  
2. Put the key in the ignition.  
3. Turn the key from the 1 (off)  
position to 3 (on).  
4. Cycle eight times rapidly (within  
10 seconds) between the 1 (off)  
position and 3 (on).  
Note: The eighth turn must end in  
the 3 (on) position.  
5. The doors will lock, then unlock,  
to confirm that the programming mode has been activated.  
6. Within 20 seconds press any button on the remote entry transmitter.  
Note: If more than 20 seconds have passed you will need to start the  
procedure over again.  
7. The doors will lock, then unlock, to confirm that this remote entry  
transmitter has been programmed.  
8. Repeat Step 6 to program each additional remote entry transmitter.  
9. Turn the ignition to the 1 (off) position after you have finished  
programming all of the remote entry transmitters.  
10. The doors will lock, then unlock, to confirm that the programming  
mode has been exited.  
77  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
SECURILOCK™ PASSIVE ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM  
SecuriLock™ passive anti-theft system is an engine immobilization  
system. This system is designed to help prevent the engine from being  
started unless a coded key programmed to your vehicle is used. The  
use of the wrong type of coded key may lead to a “no-start” condition.  
Your vehicle comes with two coded keys; additional coded keys may be  
purchased from your authorized dealer. The authorized dealer can  
program your spare keys to your vehicle or you can program the keys  
yourself. Refer to Programming spare keys for instructions on how to  
program the coded key.  
Note: The SecuriLock™ passive anti-theft system is not compatible with  
non-Ford aftermarket remote start systems. Use of these systems may  
result in vehicle starting problems and a loss of security protection.  
Note: Large metallic objects, electronic devices that are used to  
purchase gasoline or similar items, or a second coded key on the same  
key chain may cause vehicle starting issues. You need to prevent these  
objects from touching the coded key while starting the engine. These  
objects will not cause damage to the coded key, but may cause a  
momentary issue if they are too close to the key when starting the  
engine. If a problem occurs, turn the ignition off, remove all objects on  
the key chain away from the coded key and restart the engine.  
Note: Do not leave a duplicate coded key in the vehicle. Always  
take your keys and lock all doors when leaving the vehicle.  
Anti-theft indicator  
The anti-theft indicator is located in the instrument cluster.  
When the ignition is in the off  
position, the indicator will flash  
once every two seconds to  
indicate the SecuriLock™ system  
is functioning as a theft  
deterrent.  
When the ignition is in the on position, the indicator will glow for  
three seconds, then turn off, to indicate normal system functionality.  
If a problem occurs with the SecuriLock™ system, the indicator will flash  
rapidly or glow steadily when the ignition is in the on position. If this  
occurs, turn the ignition off then back to on to make sure there was no  
electronic interference with the programmed key. If the vehicle doesn’t  
start, try to start it with the 2nd programmed key and if successful  
78  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
contact your authorized dealership for key replacement. If the indicator  
still flashes rapidly or glows steadily, and the vehicle will not start,  
contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible for service.  
Replacement keys  
If your keys are lost or stolen and you don’t have an extra coded key,  
you will need to have your vehicle towed to an authorized dealer. The  
key codes need to be erased from your vehicle and new coded keys will  
need to be programmed.  
Replacing coded keys can be very costly. Store an extra programmed key  
away from the vehicle in a safe place to help prevent any  
inconveniences. Please visit an authorized dealer to purchase additional  
spare or replacement keys.  
Programming spare keys  
You can program your own coded keys to your vehicle. Please read and  
understand the entire procedure before you begin.  
Tips:  
A maximum of eight keys can be coded to your vehicle.  
Only use SecuriLock™ keys.  
You must have two previously programmed coded keys (keys that  
already operate your vehicle’s engine) and the new unprogrammed  
key(s) readily accessible.  
If two previously programmed coded keys are not available, you must  
take your vehicle to your authorized dealer to have the spare key(s)  
programmed.  
1. Insert a previously programmed  
coded key into the ignition.  
2. Turn the ignition from the 1 (off)  
position to the 3 (on) position. Keep  
the ignition in the 3 (on) position  
for at least one second, but no more  
than 10 seconds.  
3. Turn the ignition to the 1 (off)  
position.  
4. Remove the previously programmed coded key from the ignition.  
5. Within 10 seconds of removing the previously programmed coded key,  
insert the other previously programmed coded key into the ignition.  
79  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
6. Turn the ignition from the 1 (off) position to the 3 (on) position. Keep  
the ignition in the 3 (on) position for at least one second but not more  
than 10 seconds.  
7. Turn the ignition to the 1 (off) position.  
8. Remove the previously programmed coded key from the ignition.  
9. Within twenty seconds of removing the previously programmed coded  
key, insert the unprogrammed key (new/valet key) into the ignition.  
10. Turn the ignition from the 1 (off) position to the 3 (on) position.  
Keep the ignition in the 3 (on) position for at least one second, but no  
more than 10 seconds.  
11. Your new, unprogrammed key is now programmed.  
If the key has been successfully programmed it will start the vehicle’s  
engine and the theft indicator light will illuminate for three seconds and  
then go out.  
If the key was not successfully programmed, it will not start your  
vehicle’s engine and the theft indicator light will flash on and off, or stay  
on for more than three seconds. If failure repeats, bring your vehicle to  
your authorized dealer to have the new key(s) programmed.  
To program additional new unprogrammed key(s), repeat this procedure  
from Step 1 for each additional key.  
80  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
SEATING  
WARNING: Reclining the seatback can cause an occupant to  
slide under the seat’s safety belt, resulting in severe personal  
injuries in the event of a collision.  
WARNING: Do not pile cargo higher than the seatbacks to  
reduce the risk of injury in a collision or sudden stop.  
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original  
position, make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped  
behind the seatback. After returning the seatback to its original  
position, pull on the seatback to ensure that it has fully latched. An  
unlatched seat may become dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or  
collision.  
Adjustable head restraints  
Your vehicle is equipped with front row outboard head restraints that are  
vertically adjustable.  
WARNING: To minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a  
crash, the driver and passenger occupants should not sit in  
and/or operate the vehicle, until the head restraint is placed in its  
proper position. The driver should never adjust the head restraint  
while the vehicle is in motion.  
The adjustable head restraints  
consist of :  
a trimmed energy absorbing foam  
and structure (1),  
two steel stems (2),  
a guide sleeve adjust release  
button (3),  
and a guide sleeve unlock/remove  
button (4).  
81  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
To adjust the head restraint, do the following:  
1. Adjust the seatback to an upright driving/riding position.  
2. Raise the head restraint by  
pulling up on the head restraint.  
3. Lower the head restraint by  
pressing and holding the guide  
sleeve adjust release button and  
pushing down on the head restraint.  
Properly adjust the head restraint so that the top of the head restraint is  
even with the top of your head and positioned as close as possible to the  
back of your head. For occupants of extremely tall stature, adjust the  
head restraint to its full up position.  
WARNING: The adjustable head restraint is a safety device.  
Whenever possible it should be installed and properly adjusted  
when the seat is occupied.  
82  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
To remove the adjustable head restraint, do the following:  
1. Pull up the head restraint until it  
reaches the highest adjustment  
position.  
2. Simultaneously press and hold  
both the adjust/release button and  
the unlock/remove button, then pull  
up on the head restraint.  
To reinstall the adjustable head restraint, do the following:  
1. Insert the two stems into the  
guide sleeve collars.  
2. Push the head restraint down  
until it locks.  
Properly adjust the head restraint so that the top of the head restraint is  
even with the top of your head and positioned as close as possible to the  
back of your head. For occupants of extremely tall stature, adjust the  
head restraint to its full up position.  
83  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: To minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a  
crash, head restraints must be installed properly.  
Adjusting the front manual seat  
WARNING: Sitting improperly out of position or with the seat  
back reclined too far can take off weight from the seat cushion  
and affect the decision of the passenger sensing system, resulting in  
serious injury or death in a crash. Always sit upright against your  
seatback, with your feet on the floor.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of possible serious injury: Do not  
hang objects off seat back or stow objects in map pocket (if  
equipped) when a child is in the front passenger seat. Do not place  
objects underneath the front passenger seat or between the seat and  
the center console (if equipped). Check the “passenger airbag off” or  
“pass airbag off” indicator lamp for proper airbag status. Refer to Front  
passenger sensing system chapter for additional details. Failure to  
follow these instructions may interfere with the front passenger seat  
sensing system.  
Pull the lever located under the  
front edge of the seat to move the  
seat forward or backward.  
84  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Pull up on the control to raise the  
seat and push down on the control  
to lower the seat.  
Lift the control to adjust the angle  
of the seatback.  
WARNING: Reclining the seatback can cause an occupant to  
slide under the seat’s safety belt, resulting in severe personal  
injuries in the event of a collision.  
85  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Heated seats (if equipped)  
WARNING: Persons who are unable to feel pain to the skin  
because of advanced age, chronic illness, diabetes, spinal cord  
injury, medication, alcohol use, exhaustion, or other physical  
conditions, must exercise care when using the seat heater. The seat  
heater may cause burns even at low temperatures, especially if used  
for long periods of time. Do not place anything on the seat that  
insulates against heat, such as a blanket or cushion, because this may  
cause the seat heater to overheat. Do not puncture the seat with pins,  
needles, or other pointed objects because this may damage the heating  
element which may cause the seat heater to overheat. An overheated  
seat may cause serious personal injury.  
Note: Do not do the following:  
Place heavy objects on the seat  
Operate the seat heater if water or any other liquid is spilled on the  
seat. Allow the seat to dry thoroughly.  
To operate the heated seats:  
Push the button located on the  
instrument panel to activate.  
Push again to deactivate.  
The heated seats will activate when the ignition is in the on position and  
the engine is running.  
The system automatically shuts off after 10 minutes.  
86  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Tip/slide front passenger seat (if equipped)  
Lift the control and fold the  
seatback forward.  
The seat can be slid forward to  
allow easier entry to the rear seats.  
Slide the seat back and fold back  
the seatback until it locks with a  
distinct click. Rock the seat to  
ensure that the catch is securely  
engaged.  
WARNING: Do not place objects behind the seat which could  
prevent the engagement of the seat lock.  
REAR SEATS  
Rear head restraints  
Your vehicle is equipped with rear head restraints that are vertically  
adjustable.  
Raise the head restraint by pulling  
up on the head restraint.  
87  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Lower the head restraint by  
pressing and holding the guide  
sleeve release button and pushing  
down on the head restraint.  
For details about the individual components of the head restraints and  
about how to remove the head restraints, refer to Adjustable head  
restraints at the beginning of this chapter.  
Folding down the rear seat  
One or both rear seatbacks can be folded down to provide additional  
cargo space.  
To lower the seatback(s) from inside the vehicle, do the following:  
1. Lower the head restraint (if equipped) to the lowest position.  
2. Pull the strap located on the  
inboard side of the seatback  
(passenger side) or on the outboard  
side of the seatback (driver side) to  
release it.  
3. Fold the seatback down.  
When raising the seatback(s), make sure you hear the seat latch into  
place.  
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original  
position, make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped  
behind the seatback. After returning the seatback to its original  
position, pull on the seatback to ensure that it has fully latched. An  
unlatched seat may become dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or  
collision.  
88  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
SAFETY RESTRAINTS  
Personal Safety Systemா  
The Personal Safety Systemprovides an improved overall level of  
frontal crash protection to front seat occupants and is designed to help  
further reduce the risk of airbag-related injuries. The system is able to  
analyze different occupant conditions and crash severity before activating  
the appropriate safety devices to help better protect a range of  
occupants in a variety of frontal crash situations.  
Your vehicle’s Personal Safety Systemconsists of:  
Driver and passenger dual-stage airbag supplemental restraints.  
Front safety belts with pretensioners, energy management retractors,  
and safety belt usage sensors.  
Driver’s seat position sensor.  
Front crash severity sensor.  
Front passenger sensing system  
“Passenger airbag off” or “pass airbag off” indicator lamp  
Restraints Control Module (RCM) with impact and safing sensors.  
Restraint system warning light and back-up tone.  
The electrical wiring for the airbags, crash sensor(s), safety belt  
pretensioners, front safety belt usage sensors, driver seat position  
sensor, and indicator lights.  
How does the Personal Safety Systemwork?  
The Personal Safety Systemcan adapt the deployment strategy of your  
vehicle’s safety devices according to crash severity and conditions. A  
collection of crash sensors provides information to the Restraints Control  
Module (RCM). During a crash, the RCM may activate the safety belt  
pretensioners and/or either none, one, or both stages of the dual-stage  
airbag supplemental restraints based on crash severity and conditions.  
The fact that the pretensioners or airbags did not activate for both front  
seat occupants in a collision does not mean that something is wrong with  
the system. Rather, it means the Personal Safety Systemdetermined  
the accident conditions (crash severity, belt usage, etc.) were not  
appropriate to activate these safety devices. Front airbags are designed  
to activate only in frontal and near-frontal collisions, not rollovers,  
side-impacts, or rear-impacts unless the collision causes sufficient  
longitudinal deceleration.  
89  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Driver and passenger dual-stage airbag supplemental restraints  
The dual-stage airbags offer the capability to tailor the level of airbag  
inflation energy. A lower, less forceful energy level is provided for more  
common, moderate-severity impacts. A higher energy level is used for  
the most severe impacts. Refer to Airbag supplemental restraints  
(SRS) section in this chapter.  
Front crash severity sensor  
The front crash severity sensor enhances the ability to detect the  
severity of an impact. Positioned up front, it provides valuable  
information early in the crash event on the severity of the impact. This  
allows your Personal Safety Systemto distinguish between different  
levels of crash severity and modify the deployment strategy of the  
dual-stage airbags and safety belt pretensioners.  
Driver’s seat position sensor  
The driver’s seat position sensor allows your Personal Safety Systemto  
tailor the deployment level of the driver dual-stage airbag based on seat  
position. The system is designed to help protect smaller drivers sitting  
close to the driver airbag by providing a lower airbag output level.  
Front passenger sensing system  
For airbags to do their job they must inflate with great force, and this  
force can pose a potentially deadly risk to occupants that are very close  
to the airbag when it begins to inflate. For some occupants, like infants  
in rear-facing child seats, this occurs because they are initially sitting  
very close to the airbag. For other occupants, this occurs when the  
occupant is not properly restrained by safety belts or child safety seats  
and they move forward during pre-crash braking. The most effective way  
to reduce the risk of unnecessary injuries is to make sure all occupants  
are properly restrained. Accident statistics suggest that children are  
much safer when properly restrained in the rear seating positions than in  
the front.  
WARNING: Air bags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.  
NEVER place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active air  
bag. If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move  
the seat all the way back.  
WARNING: Always transport children 12 years old and under in  
the back seat and always properly use appropriate child  
restraints.  
90  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The front passenger sensing system can automatically turn off the  
passenger front airbag. The system is designed to help protect small  
(child size) occupants from airbag deployments when they are  
improperly seated or restrained in the front passenger seat contrary to  
proper child-seating or restraint usage recommendations. Even with this  
technology, parents are STRONGLY encouraged to always properly  
restrain children in the rear seat. The sensor also turns off the airbag  
when the passenger seat is empty to prevent unnecessary replacement of  
the airbag(s) after a collision.  
When the front passenger seat is occupied and the sensing system has  
turned off the passenger’s frontal airbag, the “pass airbag off” indicator  
will light and stay lit to remind you that the front passenger frontal  
airbag is off. See Front passenger sensing system in the Airbag  
supplemental restraints (SRS) section of this chapter.  
Front safety belt usage sensors  
The front safety belt usage sensors detect whether or not the driver and  
front outboard passenger safety belts are fastened. This information  
allows your Personal Safety Systemto tailor the airbag deployment and  
safety belt pretensioner activation depending upon safety belt usage.  
Front outboard safety belt pretensioners  
The safety belt pretensioners at the front outboard seating positions are  
designed to tighten the safety belts firmly against the occupant’s body  
during frontal collisions, and in side collisions when the side air curtain  
system activates. This helps increase the effectiveness of the safety belts.  
In frontal collisions, the safety belt pretensioners can be activated alone  
or, if the collision is of sufficient severity, together with the front airbags.  
Front outboard safety belt energy management retractors  
The front safety belt energy management retractors allow webbing to be  
pulled out of the retractor in a gradual and controlled manner in  
response to the occupant’s forward momentum. This helps reduce the  
risk of force-related injuries to the occupant’s chest by limiting the load  
on the occupant. Refer to the Energy management feature section in  
this chapter.  
Determining if the Personal Safety Systemis operational  
The Personal Safety Systemuses a warning light in the instrument  
cluster or a back-up tone to indicate the condition of the system. Refer  
to the Warning light section in the Instrument Cluster chapter.  
Routine maintenance of the Personal Safety Systemis not required.  
91  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The Restraints Control Module (RCM) monitors its own internal circuits  
and the circuits for the airbag supplemental restraints, crash sensor(s),  
safety belt pretensioners, front safety belt buckle sensors, front  
passenger sensing system, and the driver seat position sensor. In  
addition, the RCM also monitors the restraints warning light in the  
instrument cluster. A difficulty with the system is indicated by one or  
more of the following.  
The warning light will either flash or stay lit.  
The warning light will not illuminate immediately after ignition is  
turned on.  
A series of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will repeat  
periodically until the problem and warning light are repaired.  
If any of these things happen, even intermittently, have the Personal  
Safety Systemserviced at an authorized dealer immediately. Unless  
serviced, the system may not function properly in the event of a  
collision.  
Safety belt precautions  
WARNING: Always drive and ride with your seatback upright  
and the lap belt snug and low across the hips.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of injury, make sure children sit  
where they can be properly restrained.  
WARNING: Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap  
while the vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot protect the  
child from injury in a collision.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver,  
should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an air  
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is provided.  
WARNING: It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,  
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in  
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed. Do not  
allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped  
with seats and safety belts. Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a  
seat and using a safety belt properly.  
92  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is  
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt.  
WARNING: Each seating position in your vehicle has a specific  
safety belt assembly which is made up of one buckle and one  
tongue that are designed to be used as a pair. 1) Use the shoulder belt  
on the outside shoulder only. Never wear the shoulder belt under the  
arm. 2) Never swing the safety belt around your neck over the inside  
shoulder. 3) Never use a single belt for more than one person.  
WARNING: When possible, all children 12 years old and under  
should be properly restrained in a rear seating position.  
WARNING: Front and rear seat occupants, including pregnant  
women, should wear safety belts for optimum protection in an  
accident.  
Combination lap and shoulder belts  
1. Insert the belt tongue into the  
proper buckle (the buckle closest to  
the direction the tongue is coming  
from) until you hear a snap and feel  
it latch. Make sure the tongue is  
securely fastened in the buckle.  
93  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
2. To unfasten, push the release  
button and remove the tongue from  
the buckle.  
Energy management feature  
This vehicle has a safety belt system with an energy management  
feature at the front outboard seating positions to help further reduce  
the risk of injury in the event of a head-on collision.  
This safety belt system has a retractor assembly that is designed to  
pay out webbing in a controlled manner. This feature is designed to  
help reduce the belt force acting on the occupant’s chest.  
The front outboard and rear safety restraints in the vehicle are  
combination lap and shoulder belts. The front passenger and rear seat  
outboard safety belts have two types of locking modes.  
Vehicle sensitive mode  
The vehicle sensitive mode is the normal retractor mode, allowing free  
shoulder belt length adjustment to your movements and locking in  
response to vehicle movement. For example, if the driver brakes  
suddenly or turns a corner sharply, or the vehicle receives an impact of  
approximately 5 mph (8 km/h) or more, the combination safety belts will  
lock to help reduce forward movement of the driver and passengers.  
Automatic locking mode  
When to use the automatic locking mode  
In this mode, the shoulder belt is automatically pre-locked. The belt will  
still retract to remove any slack in the shoulder belt. The automatic  
locking mode is not available on the driver safety belt.  
This mode should be used any time a child safety seat (except a  
booster) is installed in a passenger front or outboard rear seating  
position (if equipped). Children 12 years old and under should be  
properly restrained in the rear seat whenever possible. Refer to Safety  
restraints for children or Safety seats for children later in this chapter.  
94  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
How to use the automatic locking mode  
Buckle the combination lap and  
shoulder belt.  
Grasp the shoulder portion and  
pull downward until the entire  
belt is pulled out.  
Allow the belt to retract. As the belt retracts, you will hear a clicking  
sound. This indicates the safety belt is now in the automatic locking  
mode.  
How to disengage the automatic locking mode  
WARNING: Ford Motor Company recommends that all  
passenger safety belt assemblies and attaching hardware should  
be inspected by an authorized dealer after any collision to verify that  
the Љautomatic locking retractorЉ feature for child seats is still working  
properly. Safety belt assemblies should be inspected by an authorized  
dealer and must be replaced if either damage or improper operation is  
noted. Failure to replace the belt and retractor assembly could  
increase the risk of injury in a collision.  
Unbuckle the combination lap/shoulder belt and allow it to retract  
completely to disengage the automatic locking mode and activate the  
vehicle sensitive (emergency) locking mode.  
95  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Safety belts with locking cinch tongue (rear center position only)  
The locking cinch tongue will slide up and down the belt webbing when  
the belt is in the stowed position or while putting safety belts on. When  
the locking cinch tongue of the lap/shoulder combination safety belt is  
latched into the buckle, the cinch tongue will allow the lap portion to  
become shorter, but locks the webbing in place to restrict it from  
becoming longer.  
Before you can reach and latch a combination lap and shoulder belt  
having a cinch tongue into the buckle, you may have to lengthen the lap  
belt portion of it.  
1. To lengthen the lap belt, pull  
some webbing out of the shoulder  
belt retractor.  
2. While holding the webbing below  
the tongue, grasp the tip (metal  
portion) of the tongue so that it is  
parallel to the webbing and slide the  
tongue upward.  
3. Provide enough lap belt length so that the tongue can reach the  
buckle.  
How to fasten the cinch tongue  
1. Pull the combination lap and shoulder belt from the retractor so that  
the shoulder belt portion of the safety belt crosses your shoulder and  
chest.  
2. Be sure the belt is not twisted. If the belt is twisted, remove the twist.  
3. Insert the belt tongue into the proper buckle for your seating position  
until you hear a snap and feel it latch.  
4. Make sure the tongue is securely fastened to the buckle by pulling on  
the tongue.  
WARNING: The lap belt should fit snugly and as low as possible  
around the hips, not across the waist.  
WARNING: Front and rear seat occupants, including pregnant  
women, should wear safety belts for optimum protection in an  
accident.  
96  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Each seating position in your vehicle has a specific  
safety belt assembly which is made up of one buckle and one  
tongue that are designed to be used as a pair. 1) Use the shoulder belt  
on the outside shoulder only. Never wear the shoulder belt under the  
arm. 2) Never swing the safety belt around your neck over the inside  
shoulder. 3) Never use a single belt for more than one person.  
While you are fastened in the safety belt, the combination lap/shoulder  
belt with a cinch tongue adjusts to your movement. However, if you  
brake hard, turn hard, or if your vehicle receives an impact of 8 km/h  
(5 mph) or more, the safety belt will become locked and help reduce  
your forward movement.  
Front safety belt height adjustment  
Adjust the height of the shoulder  
belt so the belt rests across the  
middle of your shoulder.  
To adjust the shoulder belt height,  
squeeze the buttons and slide the  
height adjuster up or down. Release  
the button and pull down on the  
height adjuster to make sure it is  
locked in place.  
WARNING: Position the safety belt height adjusters so that the  
belt rests across the middle of your shoulder. Failure to adjust  
the safety belt properly could reduce the effectiveness of the seat belt  
and increase the risk of injury in a collision.  
Safety belt pretensioner  
Your vehicle is equipped with safety belt pretensioners at the driver and  
front outboard passenger seating positions.  
The safety belt pretensioner tightens the safety belts firmly against the  
occupant’s body at the start of the crash.  
WARNING: The driver and front passenger safety belt system  
(including retractors, buckles and height adjusters) must be  
replaced if the vehicle is involved in a collision that results in  
deployment of front airbags, seat-mounted side airbags and side air  
curtains, and safety belt pretensioners.  
97  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Safety belt extension assembly  
If the safety belt is too short when fully extended, there is an 8 inch  
(20 cm) safety belt extension assembly that can be added (part number  
611C22). This assembly can be obtained from an authorized dealer.  
Use only extensions manufactured by the same supplier as the safety  
belt. Manufacturer identification is located at the end of the webbing on  
the label. Also, use the safety belt extension only if the safety belt is too  
short for you when fully extended.  
WARNING: Do not use extensions to change the fit of the  
shoulder belt across the torso.  
Safety belt warning light and indicator chime  
The safety belt warning light illuminates in the instrument cluster and a  
chime sounds to remind the occupants to fasten their safety belts.  
Conditions of operation  
If...  
Then...  
The driver’s safety belt is not  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the on  
position...  
The safety belt warning light  
illuminates 1-2 minutes and the  
warning chime sounds 4-8 seconds.  
The driver’s safety belt is  
buckled while the indicator  
light is illuminated and the  
warning chime is sounding...  
The driver’s safety belt is  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the on  
position...  
The safety belt warning light and  
warning chime turn off.  
The safety belt warning light and  
indicator chime remain off.  
Belt-Minderா  
The Belt-Minderfeature is a supplemental warning to the safety belt  
warning function. This feature provides additional reminders by  
intermittently sounding a chime and illuminating the safety belt warning  
light in the instrument cluster when the driver’s and front passenger’s  
safety belt is unbuckled.  
The Belt-Minderfeature uses information from the front passenger  
sensing system to determine if a front seat passenger is present and  
98  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
therefore potentially in need of a warning. To avoid activating the  
Belt-Minderfeature for objects placed in the front passenger seat,  
warnings will only be given to large front seat occupants as determined  
by the front passenger sensing system.  
Both the driver’s and passenger’s safety belt usages are monitored and  
either may activate the Belt-Minderfeature. The warnings are the same  
for the driver and the front passenger. If the Belt-Minderwarnings have  
expired (warnings for approximately five minutes) for one occupant  
(driver or front passenger), the other occupant can still activate the  
Belt-Minderfeature.  
If...  
Then...  
The driver’s and front  
passenger’s safety belts are  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the on  
position or less than  
The Belt-Minderfeature will not  
activate.  
1-2 minutes have elapsed since  
the ignition switch has been  
turned to on...  
The driver’s or front  
The Belt-Minderfeature is activated  
- the safety belt warning light  
illuminates and the warning chime  
sounds for six seconds every  
passenger’s safety belt is not  
buckled when the vehicle has  
reached at least 3 mph  
(5 km/h) and 1-2 minutes have 30 seconds, repeating for  
elapsed since the ignition  
approximately five minutes or until  
switch has been turned to on... the safety belts are buckled.  
The driver’s or front  
passenger’s safety belt becomes - the safety belt warning light  
unbuckled for approximately illuminates and the warning chime  
one minute while the vehicle is sounds for six seconds every  
The Belt-Minderfeature is activated  
traveling at least 3 mph  
(5 km/h) and more than  
30 seconds, repeating for  
approximately five minutes or until  
1-2 minutes have elapsed since the safety belts are buckled.  
the ignition switch has been  
turned to on...  
99  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The following are reasons most often given for not wearing safety belts  
(All statistics based on U.S. data):  
Reasons given... Consider...  
“Crashes are rare 36700 crashes occur every day. The more we  
events”  
drive, the more we are exposed to “rare” events,  
even for good drivers. 1 in 4 of us will be seriously  
injured in a crash during our lifetime.  
3 of 4 fatal crashes occur within 25 miles (40 km)  
of home.  
“I’m not going  
far”  
“Belts are  
uncomfortable”  
We design our safety belts to enhance comfort. If  
you are uncomfortable - try different positions for  
the safety belt upper anchorage and seatback which  
should be as upright as possible; this can improve  
comfort.  
“I was in a hurry” Prime time for an accident. Belt-Minderreminds  
us to take a few seconds to buckle up.  
“Safety belts  
don’t work”  
Safety belts, when used properly, reduce risk of  
death to front seat occupants by 45% in cars, and  
by 60% in light trucks.  
“Traffic is light” Nearly 1 of 2 deaths occur in single-vehicle  
crashes, many when no other vehicles are around.  
“Belts wrinkle  
my clothes”  
Possibly, but a serious crash can do much more than  
wrinkle your clothes, particularly if you are  
unbelted.  
“The people I’m Set the example, teen deaths occur 4 times more  
with don’t wear  
belts”  
often in vehicles with TWO or MORE people.  
Children and younger brothers/sisters imitate  
behavior they see.  
“I have an  
airbag”  
Airbags offer greater protection when used with  
safety belts. Frontal airbags are not designed to  
inflate in rear and side crashes or rollovers.  
Not a good idea. People who are ejected are 40  
times more likely to DIE. Safety belts help  
prevent ejection, WE CAN’T “PICK OUR CRASH”.  
“I’d rather be  
thrown clear”  
100  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Do not sit on top of a buckled safety belt or insert a  
latchplate into the buckle to avoid the Belt-Minderchime. To  
do so may adversely affect the performance of the vehicle’s air bag  
system.  
One-time disable  
If at any time the driver/front passenger quickly buckles then unbuckles  
the safety belt for that seating position, the Belt-Minderis disabled for  
the current ignition cycle. The Belt-Minderfeature will enable during  
the same ignition cycle if the occupant buckles and remains buckled for  
approximately 30 seconds. Confirmation is not given for the one time  
disable.  
Deactivating/activating the Belt-Minderfeature  
The driver and front passenger Belt-Minderare  
deactivated/activated independently. When deactivating/activating  
one seating position, do not buckle the other position as this will  
terminate the process.  
Read Steps 1 - 4 thoroughly before proceeding with the  
deactivation/activation programming procedure.  
Note: The driver and front passenger Belt-Minderfeatures must be  
disabled/enabled separately. Both cannot be disable/enabled during the  
same key cycle.  
The driver and front passenger Belt-Minderfeatures can be  
deactivated/activated by performing the following procedure:  
Before following the procedure, make sure that:  
The parking brake is set  
The gearshift is in P (Park) (automatic transmission) and in neutral  
(manual transmission)  
The ignition switch is in the off position  
The driver and front passenger safety belts are unbuckled  
WARNING: While the design allows you to deactivate your  
Belt-Minder, this system is designed to improve your chances of  
being safely belted and surviving an accident. We recommend you  
leave the Belt-Mindersystem activated for yourself and others who  
may use the vehicle. To reduce the risk of injury, do not  
deactivate/activate the Belt-Minderfeature while driving the vehicle.  
101  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the on position. DO NOT START THE  
ENGINE.  
2. Wait until the safety belt warning light turns off (Approximately one  
minute).  
Step 3 must be completed within 50 seconds after the safety belt  
warning light turns off.  
3. For the seating position being disabled, at a moderate speed, buckle  
then unbuckle the safety belt nine times, ending in the unbuckled state.  
Step 3 must be completed within 50 seconds after the safety belt  
warning light turns off.  
After Step 3, the safety belt warning light will be turned on for three  
seconds.  
4. Within approximately seven seconds of the light turning off, buckle  
then unbuckle the safety belt.  
This will disable the Belt-Minderfeature for that seating position if it  
is currently enabled. As confirmation, the safety belt warning light will  
flash one time per second for three seconds.  
This will enable the Belt-Minderfeature for that seating position if it  
is currently disabled. As confirmation, the safety belt warning light will  
flash four times per second for three seconds, followed by three  
seconds with the light off, then followed by the safety belt warning  
light flashing one time per second for three seconds again.  
AIRBAG SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS)  
The supplemental restraint system is designed to work with the safety  
belt to help protect the driver and right front passenger from certain  
upper body injuries.  
102  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Airbags DO NOT inflate slowly or gently, and the  
risk of injury from a deploying airbag is the greatest close to the  
trim covering the airbag module.  
Important SRS precautions  
The SRS is designed to work with  
the safety belt to help protect the  
driver and right front passenger  
from certain upper body injuries.  
Airbags DO NOT inflate slowly;  
there is a risk of injury from a  
deploying airbag.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver,  
should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an air  
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is provided.  
WARNING: When possible, all children 12 years old and under  
should be properly restrained in a rear seating position.  
WARNING: The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration  
(NHTSA) recommends a minimum distance of at least 10 inches  
(25 cm) between an occupant’s chest and the driver airbag module.  
WARNING: Never place your arm over the airbag module as a  
deploying airbag can result in serious arm fractures or other  
injuries.  
103  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
To properly position yourself away from the airbag:  
Move your seat to the rear as far as you can while still reaching the  
pedals comfortably.  
Recline the seat slightly one or two degrees from the upright position.  
WARNING: Do not put anything on or over the airbag module.  
Placing objects on or over the airbag inflation area may cause  
those objects to be propelled by the airbag into your face and torso  
causing serious injury.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the  
airbag supplemental restraint systems or its fuses. Contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
Children and airbags  
Children must always be properly  
restrained. Accident statistics  
suggest that children are safer when  
properly restrained in the rear  
seating positions than in the front  
seating position. Failure to follow  
these instructions may increase the  
risk of injury in a collision.  
WARNING: Airbags can kill  
or injure a child in a child  
seat. NEVER place a rear-facing  
child seat in front of an active  
airbag. If you must use a  
forward-facing child seat in the  
front seat, move the seat all the  
way back.  
104  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
How does the airbag supplemental restraint system work?  
The airbag SRS is designed to  
activate when the vehicle sustains  
longitudinal deceleration sufficient  
to cause the sensors to close an  
electrical circuit that initiates airbag  
inflation. The fact that the airbags  
did not inflate in a collision does not  
mean that something is wrong with  
the system. Rather, it means the  
forces were not of the type  
sufficient to cause activation. Front  
airbags are designed to inflate in  
frontal and near-frontal collisions, not rollover, side-impact, or  
rear-impacts unless the collision causes sufficient longitudinal  
deceleration.  
The airbags inflate and deflate  
rapidly upon activation. After airbag  
deployment, it is normal to notice a  
smoke-like, powdery residue or  
smell the burnt propellant. This may  
consist of cornstarch, talcum  
powder (to lubricate the bag) or  
sodium compounds (e.g., baking  
soda) that result from the  
combustion process that inflates the  
airbag. Small amounts of sodium  
hydroxide may be present which  
may irritate the skin and eyes, but  
none of the residue is toxic.  
While the system is designed to help  
reduce serious injuries, contact with  
a deploying airbag may also cause abrasions, swelling or temporary  
hearing loss. Because airbags must inflate rapidly and with considerable  
force, there is the risk of death or serious injuries such as fractures,  
facial and eye injuries or internal injuries, particularly to occupants who  
are not properly restrained or are otherwise out of position at the time  
of airbag deployment. Thus, it is extremely important that occupants be  
properly restrained as far away from the airbag module as possible while  
maintaining vehicle control.  
105  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Several air bag system components get hot after  
inflation. Do not touch them after inflation.  
WARNING: If the air bag has deployed, the air bag will not  
function again and must be replaced immediately. If the air  
bag is not replaced, the unrepaired area will increase the risk of injury  
in a collision.  
The SRS consists of:  
driver and passenger airbag modules (which include the inflators and  
airbags).  
side airbags. Refer to Seat-mounted side airbag system later in this  
chapter.  
side air curtain system. Refer to Side air curtain system later in this  
chapter.  
safety belt pretensioners  
one or more impact and safing sensors.  
Front passenger sensing system. Refer to Front passenger sensing  
system later in this chapter.  
“Passenger airbag off” or “pass airbag off” indicator lamp. Refer to  
Front passenger sensing system later in this chapter.  
a readiness light and tone.  
diagnostic module.  
and the electrical wiring which connects the components.  
The diagnostic module monitors its own internal circuits and the  
supplemental airbag electrical system wiring (including the impact  
sensors), the system wiring, the airbag system readiness light, the airbag  
back up power and the airbag ignitors.  
Front passenger sensing system  
The front passenger sensing system is designed to meet the regulatory  
requirements of Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard (FMVSS) 208  
and is designed to disable (will not inflate) the front passenger’s frontal  
airbag under certain conditions.  
The front passenger sensing system works with sensors that are part of  
the front passenger’s seat and safety belt. The sensors are designed to  
106  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
detect the presence of a properly seated occupant and determine if the  
front passenger’s frontal airbag should be enabled (may inflate) or  
disabled (will not inflate).  
The front passenger sensing system will disable (will not inflate) the  
front passenger’s frontal airbag if:  
the front passenger seat is unoccupied, or has small/medium objects in  
the front seat,  
the system determines that an infant is present in a rear-facing infant  
seat that is installed according to the manufacturer’s instructions,  
the system determines that a small child is present in a forward-facing  
child restraint that is installed according to the manufacturer’s  
instructions,  
the system determines that a small child is present in a booster seat,  
a front passenger takes his/her weight off of the seat for a period of  
time,  
a child or a small person occupies the front passenger seat.  
The front passenger sensing system will turn off the passenger seat side  
airbag if:  
the seat is empty and safety belt is unbuckled.  
The front passenger sensing system  
uses a Љpassenger airbag offЉ or  
Љpass airbag offЉ indicator which will  
illuminate and stay lit to remind you  
that the front passenger frontal  
airbag is disabled. The indicator  
lamp is located at the top of the instrument panel center stack area  
below the Hazard warning indicator and above the radio.  
Note: The indicator lamp will illuminate for a short period of time when  
the ignition is turned to the on position to confirm it is functional.  
When the front passenger seat is not occupied (empty seat) or in the  
event that the front passenger frontal airbag is enabled (may inflate), the  
indicator lamp will be unlit.  
The front passenger sensing system is designed to disable (will not  
inflate) the front passenger’s frontal airbag when a rear facing infant  
seat, a forward-facing child restraint, or a booster seat is detected.  
When the front passenger sensing system disables (will not inflate)  
the front passenger frontal airbag, the indicator lamp will illuminate  
and stay lit to remind you that the front passenger frontal airbag is  
disabled.  
107  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
If the child restraint has been installed and the indicator lamp is not  
lit, then turn the vehicle off, remove the child restraint from the  
vehicle and reinstall the restraint following the child restraint  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
The front passenger sensing system is designed to enable (may inflate)  
the front passenger’s frontal airbag anytime the system senses that a  
person of adult size is sitting properly in the front passenger seat.  
When the front passenger sensing system enables the front passenger  
frontal airbag (may inflate), the indicator will be unlit and stay unlit.  
If a person of adult size is sitting in the front passenger’s seat, but the  
Љpassenger airbag offЉ or Љpass airbag offЉ indicator lamp is lit, it is  
possible that the person isn’t sitting properly in the seat. If this happens:  
Turn the vehicle off and ask the person to place the seatback in the  
full upright position.  
Have the person sit upright in the seat, centered on the seat cushion,  
with the person’s legs comfortably extended.  
Restart the vehicle and have the person remain in this position for  
about two minutes. This will allow the system to detect that person  
and enable the passenger’s frontal airbag.  
If the indicator lamp remains lit even after this, the person should be  
advised to ride in the rear seat.  
Pass Airbag Off  
Indicator Lamp  
Occupant  
Passenger Airbag  
Empty seat  
Small child in child  
safety seat or booster  
Unlit  
Lit  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Small child with safety Lit  
belt buckled or  
unbuckled  
Disabled  
Enabled  
Adult  
Unlit  
WARNING: Even with Advanced Restraints Systems, children  
12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position.  
After all occupants have adjusted their seats and put on safety belts, it’s  
very important that they continue to sit properly. A properly seated  
occupant sits upright, leaning against the seat back, and centered on the  
108  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
seat cushion, with their feet comfortably extended on the floor. Sitting  
improperly can increase the chance of injury in a crash event. For  
example, if an occupant slouches, lies down, turns sideways, sits forward,  
leans forward or sideways, or puts one or both feet up, the chance of  
injury during a crash is greatly increased.  
WARNING: Sitting improperly out of position or with the seat  
back reclined too far can take off weight from the seat cushion  
and affect the decision of the front passenger sensing system, resulting  
in serious injury or death in a crash.  
Always sit upright against your seatback, with your feet on the floor.  
The front passenger sensing system may detect small or medium objects  
placed on the seat cushion. For most objects that are in the front  
passenger seat, the passenger airbag will be disabled. Even though the  
passenger airbag is disabled, the Љpass airbag offЉ lamp may or may not  
be illuminated according to the table below.  
Pass Airbag Off  
Indicator Lamp  
Passenger  
Airbag  
Objects  
Small (i.e. three-ring binder, small Unlit  
purse, bottled water)  
Disabled  
Medium (i.e. heavy briefcase, fully Lit  
packed luggage)  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Empty seat, or small to medium  
object with safety belt buckled  
Lit  
If you think that the status of the passenger airbag off indicator lamp is  
incorrect, check for the following:  
Objects lodged underneath the seat  
Objects between the seat cushion and the center console (if  
equipped)  
Objects hanging off the seat back  
Objects stowed in the seatback map pocket (if equipped)  
Objects placed on the occupant’s lap  
Cargo interference with the seat  
Other passengers pushing or pulling on the seat  
Rear passenger feet and knees resting or pushing on the seat  
109  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The conditions listed above may cause the weight of a properly seated  
occupant to be incorrectly interpreted by the passenger sensing system.  
The person in the front passenger seat may appear heavier or lighter due  
to the conditions described in the list above.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of possible serious injury:  
Do not stow objects in seat back map pocket (if equipped) or  
hang objects off seat back if a child is in the front passenger seat.  
Do not place objects underneath the front passenger seat or between  
the seat and the center console (if equipped).  
Check the “passenger airbag off” or “pass airbag off” indicator lamp for  
proper airbag Status.  
Failure to follow these instructions may interfere with the passenger  
seat sensing system.  
In case there is a problem with the  
front passenger sensing system, the  
airbag readiness lamp in the  
instrument cluster will stay lit.  
If the airbag readiness lamp is lit, do the following:  
The driver and/or adult passengers should check for any objects that  
may be lodged underneath the front passenger seat or cargo interfering  
with the seat.  
If objects are lodged and/or cargo is interfering with the seat; please take  
the following steps to remove the obstruction:  
Pull the vehicle over.  
Turn the vehicle off.  
Driver and/or adult passengers should check for any objects lodged  
underneath the front passenger seat or cargo interfering with the seat.  
Remove the obstruction(s) (if found).  
Restart the vehicle.  
Wait at least two minutes and verify that the airbag readiness lamp is  
no longer illuminated  
If the airbag readiness lamp remains illuminated, this may or may/not  
be a problem due to the front passenger sensing system.  
DO NOT attempt to repair or service the system; take your vehicle  
immediately to an authorized dealer.  
If it is necessary to modify an advanced front airbag system to  
accommodate a person with disabilities, contact the Ford Customer  
110  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Relationship Center at the phone number shown in the Customer  
Assistance section of this Owner’s Guide.  
WARNING: Any alteration/modification to the front passenger  
seat may affect the performance of the front passenger sensing  
system.  
Determining if the system is operational  
The supplemental restraint system uses a warning indicator light in the  
instrument cluster or a back-up tone to indicate the condition of the  
system. Refer to the Warning lights and chimes section in the  
Instrument Cluster chapter. Routine maintenance of the airbag is not  
required.  
A difficulty with the system is indicated by one or more of the following:  
The readiness light (same light  
for front and side airbag system)  
will either flash or stay lit.  
The readiness light will not  
illuminate immediately after ignition is turned on.  
A series of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will repeat  
periodically until the problem and/or light are repaired.  
If any of these things happen, even intermittently, have the supplemental  
restraint system serviced at an authorized dealer immediately. Unless  
serviced, the system may not function properly in the event of a  
collision.  
Seat-mounted side airbag system  
WARNING: Do not place objects or mount equipment on or  
near the airbag cover on the side of the seatbacks of the front  
seats or in front seat areas that may come into contact with a  
deploying airbag. Failure to follow these instructions may increase the  
risk of personal injury in the event of a collision.  
WARNING: Do not use accessory seat covers. The use of  
accessory seat covers may prevent the deployment of the side  
airbags and increase the risk of injury in an accident.  
111  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Do not lean your head on the door. The side airbag  
could injure you as it deploys from the side of the seatback.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the  
airbag SRS, its fuses or the seat cover on a seat containing an  
airbag. Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle should always wear  
their safety belts even when an airbag SRS is provided.  
How does the side airbag system work?  
The design and development of the  
side airbag system included  
recommended testing procedures  
that were developed by a group of  
automotive safety experts known as  
the Side Airbag Technical Working  
Group. These recommended testing  
procedures help reduce the risk of  
injuries related to the deployment of  
side airbags.  
The side airbag system consists of  
the following:  
An inflatable nylon bag (airbag)  
with a gas generator concealed  
behind the outboard bolster of  
the driver and front passenger  
seatbacks.  
A special seat cover designed to allow airbag deployment.  
The same warning light, electronic control and diagnostic unit as used  
for the front airbags.  
Two pressure sensors located in the front doors.  
Two crash sensors located between the “B” and “C” pillars.  
Side airbags, in combination with safety belts, can help reduce the risk of  
severe injuries in the event of a significant side impact collision.  
112  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The side airbags are fitted on the outboard side of the seatbacks of the  
front seats. In certain lateral collisions, the airbag on the side affected by  
the collision will be inflated. The front passenger sensing system will  
turn off the passenger seat side airbag if the seat is empty (unless for  
some reason the safety belt is properly buckled). The airbag was  
designed to inflate between the door panel and occupant to further  
enhance the protection provided occupants in side impact collisions.  
The airbag SRS is designed to activate when the vehicle sustains lateral  
deceleration sufficient to cause the sensors to close an electrical circuit  
that initiates airbag inflation.  
The fact that the airbags did not inflate in a collision does not mean that  
something is wrong with the system. Rather, it means the forces were  
not of the type sufficient to cause activation. Side airbags are designed  
to inflate in side-impact collisions, not roll-over, rear-impact, frontal or  
near-frontal collisions, unless the collision causes sufficient lateral  
deceleration.  
WARNING: Several air bag system components get hot after  
inflation. Do not touch them after inflation.  
WARNING: If the side  
airbag has deployed, the  
airbag will not function again.  
The side airbag system  
(including the seat) must be  
inspected and serviced by an  
authorized dealer. If the airbag  
is not replaced, the unrepaired  
area will increase the risk of injury  
in a collision.  
113  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Side curtain airbag system  
WARNING: Do not place  
objects or mount equipment  
on or near the headliner at the  
siderail that may come into  
contact with a deploying side air  
curtain. Failure to follow these  
instructions may increase the risk  
of personal injury in the event of a  
collision.  
WARNING: Do not place objects or mount equipment on or  
near the side air curtain cover.  
WARNING: Do not lean your head on the door. The side airbag  
could injure you as it deploys from the seat.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the side  
air curtain system, its fuses, the A, B, or C pillar trim, or the  
headliner on a vehicle containing a side air curtain. See your  
authorized dealer.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver,  
should always wear their safety belts even when an inflatable  
curtain is provided.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of injury, do not obstruct or  
place objects in the deployment zone of the inflatable curtain.  
114  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
How does the side air curtain system work?  
The design and development of the  
side air curtain system included  
recommended testing procedures  
that were developed by a group of  
automotive safety experts known as  
the Side Airbag Technical Working  
Group. These recommended testing  
procedures help reduce the risk of  
injuries related to the deployment of  
side airbags (including side air  
curtain systems).  
The side air curtain system consists  
of the following:  
An inflatable nylon curtain with a  
gas generator concealed behind  
the headliner and above the  
doors.  
The headliner will flex to open  
above the side doors to allow air curtain deployment.  
The same warning light, electronic control and diagnostic unit as used  
for the front airbags.  
Two pressure sensors located in the front doors.  
Two crash sensors located on the rocker panel between the “B” and  
“C” pillars near the floor.  
Side air curtains and side airbags, in combination with safety belts, can  
help reduce the risk of severe injuries in the event of a significant side  
impact collision.  
Children 12 years old and under should always be properly restrained in  
the rear seats. The side air curtain will not interfere with children  
restrained using a properly installed child or booster seat because it is  
designed to inflate downward from the headliner above the doors along  
the side window openings.  
The side air curtains are mounted to the sheet metal above the first and  
second row seats. In certain lateral collisions, the air curtain and  
seat-mounted side airbag on the side affected by the collision will be  
inflated, except that the passenger sensing system will deactivate the  
passenger seat-mounted side airbag if it detects an empty unbuckled  
passenger seat. The air curtain was designed to inflate between the side  
115  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
window area and occupant to further enhance the head protection  
provided to occupants in side impact collisions. The seat-mounted side  
airbag was designed to inflate between the door panel and occupant to  
further enhance the protection provided occupants in side impact  
collisions.  
The side air curtain system SRS is designed to activate when the vehicle  
sustains lateral deceleration sufficient to cause the sensors to close an  
electrical circuit that initiates air curtain and seat-mounted side airbag  
inflation.  
The fact that the side air curtain and seat-mounted side airbag did not  
inflate in a collision does not mean that something is wrong with the  
system. Rather, it means the forces were not of the type sufficient to  
cause activation. The side air curtain system is designed to inflate in side  
impact collisions, not roll-over, rear impact, frontal or near-frontal  
collisions, unless the collision causes sufficient lateral deceleration.  
WARNING: Several air bag system components get hot after  
inflation. Do not touch them after inflation.  
WARNING: If the side air  
curtain has deployed, the  
air curtain will not function  
again. The side air curtain  
system (including the A, B and  
C pillar trim and headliner)  
must be inspected and serviced  
by an authorized dealer. If the  
air curtain is not replaced, the  
unrepaired area will increase the  
risk of injury in a collision.  
Determining if the system is operational  
The SRS uses a readiness light in the instrument cluster or a tone to  
indicate the condition of the system. Refer to the Airbag readiness  
section in the Instrument Cluster chapter. Routine maintenance of the  
side airbag is not required.  
A difficulty with the system is indicated by one or more of the following:  
The readiness light (same light as for front airbag system) will either  
flash or stay lit.  
116  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The readiness light will not illuminate immediately after ignition is  
turned on.  
A series of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will repeat  
periodically until the problem and/or light are repaired.  
If any of these things happen, even intermittently, have the SRS serviced  
at your authorized dealer immediately. Unless serviced, the system may  
not function properly in the event of a collision.  
S.O.S. Post Crash Alert  
The S.O.S Post Crash Alert automatically flashes the turn signal lamps  
and sounds the horn three times at four second intervals in the event of  
a serious impact that deploys an airbag (front, side, side curtain or  
Safety Canopy) or the safety belt pretensioners.  
The S.O.S. Post Crash Alert can be turned off when any one of the  
following actions are taken by the driver or any other person:  
pressing the hazard control button,  
or pressing the panic button on the remote entry transmitter.  
The feature will continue to operate until the vehicle runs out of power.  
Disposal of airbags and airbag equipped vehicles  
(including pretensioners)  
Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible. Airbags MUST BE  
disposed of by qualified personnel.  
117  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
SAFETY RESTRAINTS FOR CHILDREN  
See the following sections for directions on how to properly use safety  
restraints for children. Also see Airbag supplemental restraint system  
(SRS) in this chapter for special instructions about using airbags.  
Important child restraint precautions  
WARNING: Always make sure your child is secured properly in  
a device that is appropriate for their height, age and weight.  
Child safety restraints must be purchased separately from the vehicle.  
Failure to follow these instructions and guidelines may result in an  
increased risk of serious injury or death to your child.  
WARNING: All children are shaped differently. The  
Recommendations for Safety Restraints are based on probable  
child height, age and weight thresholds from NHTSA and other safety  
organizations or are the minimum requirements of law. Ford  
recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger Safety  
Technician (CPST) and your pediatrician to make sure your child seat  
is appropriate for your child, and is compatible with and properly  
installed in the vehicle. To locate a child seat fitting station and CPST  
contact the NHTSA toll free at 1-888-327-4236 or on the internet at  
http://www.nhtsa.dot.gov. Failure to properly restrain children in safety  
seats made especially for their height, age, and weight may result in an  
increased risk of serious injury or death to your child.  
118  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Recommendations for Safety Restraints for Children  
Recommended re-  
Child size, height, weight, or age  
straint type  
Infants Children weighing 40 lb (18 kg) or less Use a child safety  
or tod- (generally age four or younger)  
dlers  
seat (sometimes  
called an infant car-  
rier, convertible seat,  
or toddler seat).  
Small  
chil-  
dren  
Children who have outgrown or no  
Use a belt-positioning  
longer properly fit in a child safety seat booster seat.  
(generally children who are less than  
4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) tall, are  
greater than age four (4) and less than  
age twelve (12), and between 40 lbs  
(18 kg) and 80 lbs (36 kg) and upward  
to 100 lbs (45 kg) if recommended by  
your child restraint manufacturer)  
Larger Children who have outgrown or no  
Use a vehicle safety  
longer properly fit in a belt-positioning belt having the lap  
booster seat (generally children who are belt snug and low  
chil-  
dren  
at least 4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters)  
tall or greater than 80 lb (36 kg) or  
across the hips,  
shoulder belt cen-  
100 lb (45 kg) if recommended by child tered across the  
restraint manufacturer)  
shoulder and chest,  
and seatback upright.  
You are required by law to properly use safety seats for infants and  
toddlers in the U.S. and Canada.  
Many states and provinces require that small children use approved  
booster seats until they reach age eight, a height of 4 ft 9 in  
(1.45 meters) tall, or 80 lb (36 kg). Check your local and state or  
provincial laws for specific requirements regarding the safety of  
children in your vehicle.  
When possible, always properly restrain children twelve (12) years of  
age and under in a rear seating position of your vehicle. Accident  
statistics suggest that children are safer when properly restrained in  
the rear seating positions than in a front seating position.  
119  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Recommendations for attaching child safety restraints for children  
Use any attachment method as indicated be-  
low by “X”  
LATCH LATCH Safety Safety  
(lower (lower belt belt and belt  
anchors and  
only) top  
Safety  
Re-  
straint  
Type  
an-  
chors  
and  
LATCH  
(lower  
only  
Child  
Weight  
tether anchors  
anchor and top  
tether  
top  
tether  
an-  
anchor)  
chor)  
Rear fac- Up to  
ing child 48 lb  
X
X
seat  
(21 kg)  
Forward Up to  
facing  
child seat (21 kg)  
Forward Over  
facing  
48 lb  
X
X
X
X
X
48 lb  
child seat (21 kg)  
WARNING: Air bags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.  
NEVER place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active air  
bag. If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move  
the vehicle seat all the way back. When possible, all children age 12  
and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating position. If  
all children cannot be seated and restrained properly in a rear seating  
position, properly restrain the largest child in the front seat.  
120  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Always carefully follow the instructions and  
warnings provided by the manufacturer of any child restraint to  
determine if the restraint device is appropriate for your child’s size,  
height, weight, or age. Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s  
instructions and warnings provided for installation and use in  
conjunction with the instructions and warnings provided by the vehicle  
manufacturer. A safety seat that is improperly installed or utilized, is  
inappropriate for your child’s height, age, or weight or does not  
properly fit the child may increase the risk of serious injury or death.  
WARNING: Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap  
while the vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot protect the  
child from injury in a collision, which may result in serious injury or  
death.  
WARNING: Never use pillows, books, or towels to boost a child.  
They can slide around and increase the likelihood of injury or  
death in a collision.  
WARNING: Always restrain an unoccupied child seat or booster  
seat. These objects may become projectiles in a collision or  
sudden stop, which may increase the risk of serious injury.  
WARNING: Never place, or allow a child to place, the shoulder  
belt under a child’s arm or behind the back because it reduces  
the protection for the upper part of the body and may increase the risk  
of injury or death in a collision.  
WARNING: Do not leave children, unreliable adults, or pets  
unattended in your vehicle.  
121  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Transporting children  
Always make sure your child is secured properly in a device that is  
appropriate for their age, height and weight. All children are shaped  
differently. The child height, age and weight thresholds provided are  
recommendations or the minimum requirements of law. The National  
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) provides education and  
training to ensure that all children ages 0 to 16 are properly restrained in  
the correct restraint system. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA  
Certified Child Passenger Safety Technician (CPST) and your  
pediatrician to make sure your seat is appropriate for your child and  
properly installed in the vehicle. To locate a child seat fitting station and  
CPST contact the NHTSA toll free at 1-888-327-4236 or on the internet  
at http://www.nhtsa.dot.gov.  
Follow all the safety restraint and airbag precautions that apply to adult  
passengers in your vehicle.  
If the child is the proper height, age, and weight (as specified by your  
child safety seat or booster manufacturer), fits the restraint and can be  
restrained properly, then restrain the child in the child safety seat or  
with the belt-positioning booster. Remember that child seats and  
belt-positioning boosters vary and may be designed to fit children of  
different heights, ages and weights. Children who are too large for child  
safety seats or belt-positioning boosters (as specified by your child safety  
seat manufacturer) should always properly wear safety belts.  
122  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
SAFETY SEATS FOR CHILDREN  
Infant and/or toddler seats  
Use a safety seat that is recommended for the size and weight of the  
child.  
When installing a child safety seat:  
Review and follow the information  
presented in the Airbag  
supplemental restraint system  
(SRS) section in this chapter.  
Carefully follow all of the  
manufacturer’s instructions  
included with the safety seat you  
put in your vehicle. If you do not  
install and use the safety seat  
properly, the child may be injured  
in a sudden stop or collision.  
Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat. NEVER place a  
rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag. If you must use a  
forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the vehicle seat all the  
way back.  
Children 12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position whenever possible. If all children cannot be seated and  
restrained properly in a rear seating position, properly restrain the  
largest child in the front seat.  
Installing child safety seats with combination lap and shoulder  
belts  
Check to make sure the child seat is properly secured before each use.  
Children 12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position whenever possible. If all children cannot be seated and  
restrained properly in a rear seating position, properly restrain the  
largest child in the front seat.  
When installing a child safety seat with combination lap/shoulder belts:  
Use the correct safety belt buckle for that seating position.  
Insert the belt tongue into the proper buckle until you hear a snap  
and feel it latch. Make sure the tongue is securely fastened in the  
buckle.  
Keep the buckle release button pointing up and away from the safety  
seat, with the tongue between the child seat and the release button,  
to prevent accidental unbuckling.  
123  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Place vehicle seat back in upright position.  
Put the safety belt in the automatic locking mode. Refer to Step 5  
below.  
WARNING: Depending on where you secure a child restraint,  
and depending on the child restraint design, you may block  
access to certain safety belt buckle assemblies and/or LATCH lower  
anchors, rendering those features potentially unusable. To avoid risk of  
injury, occupants should only use seating positions where they are able  
to be properly restrained.  
Perform the following steps when installing the child seat with  
combination lap/shoulder belts:  
Note: Although the child seat illustrated is a forward facing child seat,  
the steps are the same for installing a rear facing child seat.  
1. Position the child safety seat in a  
seat with a combination lap and  
shoulder belt.  
2. Pull down on the shoulder belt  
and then grasp the shoulder belt  
and lap belt together.  
124  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
3. While holding the shoulder and  
lap belt portions together, route the  
tongue through the child seat  
according to the child seat  
manufacturer’s instructions. Be sure  
the belt webbing is not twisted.  
4. Insert the belt tongue into the  
proper buckle (the buckle closest to  
the direction the tongue is coming  
from) for that seating position until  
you hear a snap and feel the latch  
engage. Make sure the tongue is  
latched securely by pulling on it.  
5. To put the retractor in the  
automatic locking mode, grasp the  
shoulder portion of the belt and pull  
downward until all of the belt is  
pulled out.  
Note: The automatic locking mode  
is available on the front passenger  
and rear outboard seats only. The  
rear center seating position has a  
cinch tongue. Refer to Installing  
child safety seats in cinch tongue  
combination lap shoulder belt seating positions (rear center position  
only) in this chapter.  
6. Allow the belt to retract to remove slack. The belt will click as it  
retracts to indicate it is in the automatic locking mode.  
125  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
7. Try to pull the belt out of the retractor to make sure the retractor is  
in the automatic locking mode (you should not be able to pull more belt  
out). If the retractor is not locked, unbuckle the belt and repeat Steps 5  
and 6.  
8. Remove remaining slack from the  
belt. Force the seat down with extra  
weight, e.g., by pressing down or  
kneeling on the child restraint while  
pulling up on the shoulder belt in  
order to force slack from the belt.  
This is necessary to remove the  
remaining slack that will exist once  
the additional weight of the child is  
added to the child restraint. It also  
helps to achieve the proper  
snugness of the child seat to the  
vehicle. Sometimes, a slight lean  
towards the buckle will additionally  
help to remove remaining slack from the belt.  
9. Attach the tether strap (if the child seat is equipped). Refer to  
Attaching child safety seats with tether straps later in this chapter.  
10. Before placing the child in the  
seat, forcibly move the seat forward  
and back to make sure the seat is  
securely held in place. To check  
this, grab the seat at the belt path  
and attempt to move it side to side  
and forward and back. There should  
be no more than one inch (2.5 cm)  
of movement for proper installation.  
11. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger  
Safety Technician (CPST) to make certain the child restraint is properly  
installed.  
126  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Installing child safety seats in cinch tongue combination lap and  
shoulder belt seating positions (rear center position only)  
The belt webbing below the tongue is the lap portion of the combination  
lap/shoulder belt, and the belt webbing above the tongue is the shoulder  
belt portion of the combination lap/shoulder belt.  
Note: Although the child seat illustrated is a forward facing child seat,  
the steps are the same for installing a rear facing child seat.  
1. Position the child safety seat in a  
seat with a combination lap and  
shoulder belt.  
WARNING: Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat. If  
you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move  
seat all the way back.  
WARNING: Rear facing child seats should NEVER be placed in  
front of an active airbag.  
2. Slide the tongue up the webbing.  
127  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
3. While holding both shoulder and  
lap portions next to the tongue,  
route the tongue and webbing  
through the child seat according to  
the child seat manufacturer’s  
instructions. Be sure that the belt  
webbing is not twisted.  
4. Insert the belt tongue into the  
proper buckle for that seating  
positions until you hear a snap and  
feel it latch. Make sure the tongue is  
securely latched to the buckle by  
pulling on the tongue.  
128  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
5. Remove remaining slack from the  
belt. Force the seat down with extra  
weight, e.g., by pressing down or  
kneeling on the child restraint while  
pulling up on the shoulder belt in  
order to force slack from the belt.  
This is necessary to remove the  
remaining slack that will exist once  
the additional weight of the child is  
added to the child restraint. It also  
helps to achieve the proper  
snugness of the child seat to the  
vehicle. Sometimes, a slight lean  
towards the buckle will additionally  
help to remove remaining slack from the belt.  
6. Attach the tether strap (if the child seat is equipped). Refer to  
Attaching child safety seats with tether straps later in this chapter.  
7. Before placing the child in the  
seat, forcibly move the seat forward  
and back to make sure the seat is  
securely held in place. To check  
this, grab the seat at the belt path  
and attempt to move it side to side  
and forward and back. There should  
be no more than one inch (2.5 cm)  
of movement for proper installation.  
8. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger  
Safety Technician (CPST) to make certain the child restraint is properly  
installed.  
Attaching child safety seats with Lower Anchor and Tethers for  
CHildren (LATCH) attachments  
The LATCH system is composed of three vehicle anchor points: two (2)  
lower anchors located where the vehicle seat back and seat cushion meet  
(called the “seat bight”) and one (1) top tether anchor located behind  
that seating position.  
LATCH compatible child safety seats have two rigid or webbing mounted  
attachments that connect to the two lower anchors at the LATCH  
equipped seating positions in your vehicle. This type of attachment  
129  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
method eliminates the need to use safety belts to attach the child seat,  
however the safety belt can still be used to attach the child seat. For  
forward-facing child seats, the top tether strap must also be attached to  
the proper top tether anchor, if a top tether strap has been provided  
with your child seat. Ford Motor Company recommends the use of a  
child safety seat having a top tether strap. See Attaching child safety  
seats with tether straps and Recommendations for attaching safety  
restraints for children in this chapter for more information.  
Your vehicle has LATCH lower  
anchors for child seat installation at  
the seating positions marked with  
the child seat symbol.  
The LATCH anchors are located at  
the rear section of the rear seat  
between the cushion and seatback.  
Follow the child seat manufacturer’s  
instructions to properly install a  
child seat with LATCH attachments.  
Follow the instructions on attaching child safety seats with tether straps.  
Refer to Attaching child safety seats with tether straps later in this  
chapter.  
Attach LATCH lower attachments of the child seat only to the anchors  
shown.  
WARNING: Never attach two child safety seats to the same  
anchor. In a crash, one anchor may not be strong enough to hold  
two child safety seat attachments and may break, causing serious  
injury or death.  
130  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Depending on where you secure a child restraint,  
and depending on the child restraint design, you may block  
access to certain safety belt buckle assemblies and/or LATCH lower  
anchors, rendering those features potentially unusable. To avoid risk of  
injury, occupants should only use seating positions where they are able  
to be properly restrained.  
Use of inboard lower anchors from the outboard seating positions  
(center seating use)  
The lower anchors at the center of the second row rear seat are spaced  
450 mm (18 inches) apart. The standardized spacing for LATCH lower  
anchors is 280 mm (11 inches) center to center. A child seat with rigid  
LATCH attachments cannot be installed at the center seating position.  
LATCH compatible child seats (with attachments on belt webbing) can  
only be used at this seating position provided that the child seat  
manufacturer’s instructions permit use with the anchor spacing stated.  
Do not attach a child seat to any lower anchor if an adjacent child seat is  
attached to that anchor.  
WARNING: The standardized spacing for LATCH lower anchors  
is 280 mm (11 inches) center to center. Do not use LATCH  
lower anchors for the center seating position unless the child seat  
manufacturer’s instructions permit and specify using anchors spaced at  
least as far apart as those in this vehicle.  
If you install a child seat with rigid LATCH attachments, do not tighten  
the tether strap enough to lift the child seat off the vehicle seat cushion  
when the child is seated in it. Keep the tether strap just snug without  
lifting the front of the child seat. Keeping the child seat just touching the  
vehicle seat gives the best protection in a severe crash.  
Each time you use the safety seat, check that the seat is properly  
attached to the lower anchors and tether anchor, if applicable. Tug the  
child seat from side to side and forward and back where it is secured to  
the vehicle. The seat should move less than one inch when you do this  
for a proper installation.  
If the safety seat is not anchored properly, the risk of a child being  
injured in a crash greatly increases.  
131  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Combining safety belt and LATCH lower anchors for attaching  
child safety seats  
When used in combination, either the safety belt or the LATCH lower  
anchors may be attached first, provided a proper installation is achieved.  
Attach the tether strap afterward, if included with the child seat. Refer  
to Recommendations for attaching safety restraints for children in  
this chapter.  
Attaching child safety seats with tether straps  
Many forward-facing child safety seats include a tether strap which  
extends from the back of the child safety seat and hooks to an anchoring  
point called the top tether anchor. Tether straps are available as an  
accessory for many older safety seats. Contact the manufacturer of your  
child seat for information about ordering a tether strap, or to obtain a  
longer tether strap if the tether strap on your safety seat does not reach  
the appropriate top tether anchor in the vehicle.  
The rear seats of your vehicle are equipped with built-in tether strap  
anchors located behind the seats as described below.  
The tether anchors in your vehicle are located under a cover marked  
with the tether anchor symbol (shown with title).  
The tether strap anchors in your  
vehicle are in the following positions  
(shown from top view):  
Attach the tether strap only to the appropriate tether anchor as shown.  
The tether strap may not work properly if attached somewhere other  
than the correct tether anchor.  
Once the child safety seat has been installed using either the safety belt,  
the lower anchors of the LATCH system, or both, you can attach the top  
tether strap.  
Perform the following steps to install a child safety seat with tether  
anchors:  
1. Route the child safety seat tether strap over the back of the seat.  
For vehicles with adjustable head restraints, route the tether strap under  
the head restraint and between the head restraint posts, otherwise route  
the tether strap over the top of the seatback.  
132  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
2. Locate the correct anchor for the  
selected seating position.  
3. Open the tether anchor cover.  
4. Clip the tether strap to the  
anchor as shown.  
If the tether strap is clipped  
incorrectly, the child safety seat may  
not be retained properly in the  
event of a collision.  
5. Tighten the child safety seat tether strap according to the  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
If the safety seat is not anchored properly, the risk of a child being  
injured in a collision greatly increases.  
Child booster seats  
The belt-positioning booster (booster seat) is used to improve the fit of  
the vehicle safety belt. Children outgrow a typical child seat (e.g.,  
convertible or toddler seat) when they weigh about 40 lb (18 kg) and are  
around four (4) years of age. Consult your child safety seat owner guide  
for the weight, height, and age limits specific to your child safety seat.  
Keep your child in the child safety seat if it properly fits the child,  
remains appropriate for their weight, height and age AND if properly  
secured to the vehicle.  
133  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Although the lap/shoulder belt will provide some protection, children  
who have outgrown a typical child seat are still too small for lap/shoulder  
belts to fit properly, and wearing an improperly fitted vehicle safety belt  
could increase the risk of serious injury in a crash. To improve the fit of  
both the lap and shoulder belt on children who have outgrown child  
safety seats, Ford Motor Company recommends use of a belt-positioning  
booster.  
Booster seats position a child so that vehicle lap/shoulder safety belts fit  
better. They lift the child up so that the lap belt rests low across the hips  
and the knees bend comfortably at the edge of the cushion, while  
minimizing slouching. Booster seats may also make the shoulder belt fit  
better and more comfortably. Try to keep the belt near the middle of the  
shoulder and across the center of the chest. Moving the child closer (a  
few centimeters or inches) to the center of the vehicle, but remaining in  
the same seating position, may help provide a good shoulder belt fit.  
When children should use booster seats  
Children need to use booster seats from the time they outgrow the  
toddler seat until they are big enough for the vehicle seat and  
lap/shoulder belt to fit properly. Generally this is when they reach a  
height of at least 4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) tall (around age eight to  
age twelve and between 40 lb (18 kg) and 80 lb (36 kg) or upward to  
100 lb (45 kg) if recommended by your child restraint manufacturer).  
Many state and provincial laws require that children use approved  
booster seats until they reach age eight, a height of 4 feet 9 inches  
(1.45 meters) tall, or 80 lb (36 kg).  
Booster seats should be used until you can answer YES to ALL of these  
questions when seated without a booster seat:  
Can the child sit all the way back  
against the vehicle seat back with  
knees bent comfortably at the  
edge of the seat cushion?  
Can the child sit without  
slouching?  
Does the lap belt rest low across the hips?  
Is the shoulder belt centered on the shoulder and chest?  
Can the child stay seated like this for the whole trip?  
134  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Types of booster seats  
There are generally two types of belt-positioning booster seats: backless  
and high back. Always use booster seats in conjunction with the vehicle  
lap/shoulder belt.  
Backless booster seats  
If your backless booster seat has a  
removable shield, remove the  
shield. If a vehicle seating position  
has a low seat back or no head  
restraint, a backless booster seat  
may place your child’s head (as  
measured at the tops of the ears)  
above the top of the seat. In this  
case, move the backless booster  
to another seating position with a  
higher seat back or head restraint and lap/shoulder belts, or consider  
using a high back booster seat.  
High back booster seats  
If, with a backless booster seat,  
you cannot find a seating position  
that adequately supports your  
child’s head, a high back booster  
seat would be a better choice.  
135  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Children and booster seats vary in size and shape. Choose a booster that  
keeps the lap belt low and snug across the hips, never up across the  
stomach, and lets you adjust the shoulder belt to cross the chest and  
rest snugly near the center of the shoulder. The drawings below compare  
the ideal fit (center) to a shoulder belt uncomfortably close to the neck  
and a shoulder belt that could slip off the shoulder. The drawings below  
also show how the lap belt should be low and snug across the child’s  
hips.  
If the booster seat slides on the vehicle seat, placing a rubberized mesh  
sold as shelf or carpet liner under the booster seat may improve this  
condition. Do not introduce any item thicker than this under the booster  
seat. Check with the booster seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
136  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The importance of shoulder belts  
Using a booster without a shoulder belt increases the risk of a child’s  
head hitting a hard surface in a collision. For this reason, you should  
never use a booster seat with a lap belt only. It is generally best to use a  
booster seat with lap/shoulder belts in the back seat.  
Move a child to a different seating location if the shoulder belt does not  
stay positioned on the shoulder during use.  
Follow all instructions provided by the manufacturer of the booster seat.  
WARNING: Never place, or allow a child to place, the shoulder  
belt under a child’s arm or behind the back because it reduces  
the protection for the upper part of the body and may increase the risk  
of injury or death in a collision.  
Child restraint and safety belt maintenance  
Inspect the vehicle safety belts and child safety seat systems periodically  
to make sure they work properly and are not damaged. Inspect the  
vehicle and child seat safety belts to make sure there are no nicks, tears  
or cuts. Replace if necessary. All vehicle safety belt assemblies, including  
retractors, buckles, front safety belt buckle assemblies, buckle support  
assemblies (slide bar-if equipped), shoulder belt height adjusters (if  
equipped), shoulder belt guide on seatback (if equipped), child safety  
seat LATCH and tether anchors, and attaching hardware, should be  
inspected after a collision. Refer to the child restraint manufacturer’s  
instructions for additional inspection and maintenance information  
specific to the child restraint. Ford Motor Company recommends that all  
safety belt assemblies in use in vehicles involved in a collision be  
replaced. However, if the collision was minor and an authorized dealer  
finds that the belts do not show damage and continue to operate  
properly, they do not need to be replaced. Safety belt assemblies not in  
use during a collision should also be inspected and replaced if either  
damage or improper operation is noted.  
For proper care of soiled safety belts, refer to Interior in the Cleaning  
chapter.  
WARNING: Failure to inspect and if necessary replace the  
safety belt assembly or child restraint system under the above  
conditions could result in severe personal injuries in the event of a  
collision.  
137  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
INFORMATION ABOUT UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADING  
Tire Quality Grades apply to new  
pneumatic passenger car tires. The  
Quality grades can be found where  
applicable on the tire sidewall  
between tread shoulder and  
maximum section width. For  
example:  
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A  
These Tire Quality Grades are determined by standards that the United  
States Department of Transportation has set.  
Tire Quality Grades apply to new pneumatic passenger car tires. They do  
not apply to deep tread, winter-type snow tires, space-saver or  
temporary use spare tires, light truck or “LT” type tires, tires with  
nominal rim diameters of 10 to 12 inches or limited production tires as  
defined in Title 49 Code of Federal Regulations Part 575.104(c)(2).  
U.S. Department of Transportation-Tire quality grades: The U.S.  
Department of Transportation requires Ford Motor Company to give you  
the following information about tire grades exactly as the government  
has written it.  
Treadwear  
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of  
the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified  
government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one  
and one-half (112) times as well on the government course as a tire  
graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual  
conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the  
norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices, and  
differences in road characteristics and climate.  
Traction AA A B C  
The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B, and C. The  
grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured  
under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of  
asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction  
performance.  
138  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on  
straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include  
acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning or peak traction characteristics.  
Temperature A B C  
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C, representing the  
tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat  
when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory  
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire  
to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to  
sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance  
which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle  
Safety Standard No. 139. Grades B and A represent higher levels of  
performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by  
law.  
WARNING: The temperature grade for this tire is established  
for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive  
speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in  
combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.  
TIRES  
Tires are designed to give many thousands of miles of service, but they  
must be maintained in order to get the maximum benefit from them.  
Glossary of tire terminology  
Tire label: A label showing the OE (Original Equipment) tire sizes,  
recommended inflation pressure and the maximum weight the vehicle  
can carry.  
Tire Identification Number (TIN): A number on the sidewall of  
each tire providing information about the tire brand and  
manufacturing plant, tire size and date of manufacture. Also referred  
to as DOT code.  
Inflation pressure: A measure of the amount of air in a tire.  
Standard load: A class of P-metric or Metric tires designed to carry a  
maximum load at 35 psi [37 psi (2.5 bar) for Metric tires]. Increasing  
the inflation pressure beyond this pressure will not increase the tire’s  
load carrying capability.  
Extra load: A class of P-metric or Metric tires designed to carry a  
heavier maximum load at 41 psi [43 psi (2.9 bar) for Metric tires].  
139  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Increasing the inflation pressure beyond this pressure will not increase  
the tire’s load carrying capability.  
kPa: Kilopascal, a metric unit of air pressure.  
PSI: Pounds per square inch, a standard unit of air pressure.  
Cold inflation pressure: The tire pressure when the vehicle has  
been stationary and out of direct sunlight for an hour or more and  
prior to the vehicle being driven for 1 mile (1.6 km).  
Recommended inflation pressure: The cold inflation pressure found  
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label located on  
the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door.  
B-pillar: The structural member at the side of the vehicle behind the  
front door.  
Bead area of the tire: Area of the tire next to the rim.  
Sidewall of the tire: Area between the bead area and the tread.  
Tread area of the tire: Area of the perimeter of the tire that  
contacts the road when mounted on the vehicle.  
Rim: The metal support (wheel) for a tire or a tire and tube assembly  
upon which the tire beads are seated.  
INFLATING YOUR TIRES  
Safe operation of your vehicle requires that your tires are properly  
inflated. Remember that a tire can lose up to half of its air pressure  
without appearing flat.  
Every day before you drive, check your tires. If one looks lower than the  
others, use a tire gauge to check pressure of all tires and adjust if  
required.  
At least once a month and before long trips, inspect each tire and check  
the tire pressure with a tire gauge (including spare, if equipped). Inflate  
all tires to the inflation pressure recommended by Ford Motor Company.  
You are strongly urged to buy a reliable tire pressure gauge, as automatic  
service station gauges may be inaccurate. Ford recommends the use of a  
digital or dial-type tire pressure gauge rather than a stick-type tire  
pressure gauge.  
Use the recommended cold inflation pressure for optimum tire  
performance and wear. Under-inflation or over-inflation may cause  
uneven treadwear patterns.  
140  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: Under-inflation is the most common cause of tire  
failures and may result in severe tire cracking, tread separation  
or ЉblowoutЉ, with unexpected loss of vehicle control and increased risk  
of injury. Under-inflation increases sidewall flexing and rolling  
resistance, resulting in heat buildup and internal damage to the tire. It  
also may result in unnecessary tire stress, irregular wear, loss of  
vehicle control and accidents. A tire can lose up to half of its air  
pressure and not appear to be flat!  
Always inflate your tires to the Ford recommended inflation pressure  
even if it is less than the maximum inflation pressure information found  
on the tire. The Ford recommended tire inflation pressure is found on  
the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label which is located  
on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. Failure to follow the tire  
pressure recommendations can cause uneven treadwear patterns and  
adversely affect the way your vehicle handles.  
Maximum Permissible Inflation Pressure is the tire manufacturer’s  
maximum permissible pressure and/or the pressure at which the  
maximum load can be carried by the tire. This pressure is normally  
higher than the manufacturer’s recommended cold inflation pressure  
which can be found on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire  
Label which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door.  
The cold inflation pressure should never be set lower than the  
recommended pressure on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or  
Tire Label.  
When weather temperature changes occur, tire inflation pressures also  
change. A 10°F (6°C) temperature drop can cause a corresponding drop  
of 1 psi (7 kPa) in inflation pressure. Check your tire pressures  
frequently and adjust them to the proper pressure which can be found  
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label.  
To check the pressure in your tire(s):  
1. Make sure the tires are cool, meaning they are not hot from driving  
even a mile.  
If you are checking tire pressure when the tire is hot, (i.e. driven more  
than 1 mile [1.6 km]), never “bleed” or reduce air pressure. The tires are  
hot from driving and it is normal for pressures to increase above  
recommended cold pressures. A hot tire at or below recommended cold  
inflation pressure could be significantly under-inflated.  
141  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Note: If you have to drive a distance to get air for your tire(s), check  
and record the tire pressure first and add the appropriate air pressure  
when you get to the pump. It is normal for tires to heat up and the air  
pressure inside to go up as you drive.  
2. Remove the cap from the valve on one tire, then firmly press the tire  
gauge onto the valve and measure the pressure.  
3. Add enough air to reach the recommended air pressure.  
Note: If you overfill the tire, release air by pushing on the metal stem in  
the center of the valve. Then recheck the pressure with your tire gauge.  
4. Replace the valve cap.  
5. Repeat this procedure for each tire, including the spare.  
Note: Some spare tires operate at a higher inflation pressure than the  
other tires. For T-type/mini-spare tires (see the Dissimilar spare  
tire/wheel information section for description): Store and maintain at  
60 psi (4.15 bar). For Full Size and Dissimilar spare tires (see the  
Dissimilar spare tire/wheel information section for description): Store  
and maintain at the higher of the front and rear inflation pressure as  
shown on the Tire Label.  
6. Visually inspect the tires to make sure there are no nails or other  
objects embedded that could poke a hole in the tire and cause an air  
leak.  
7. Check the sidewalls to make sure there are no gouges, cuts or bulges.  
TIRE CARE  
Inspecting your tires  
Periodically inspect the tire treads for uneven or excessive wear and  
remove objects such as stones, nails or glass that may be wedged in the  
tread grooves. Check for holes or cuts that may permit air leakage from  
the tire and make necessary repairs. Also inspect the tire sidewalls for  
cracking, cuts, bruises and other signs of damage or excessive wear. If  
internal damage to the tire is suspected, have the tire demounted and  
inspected in case it needs to be repaired or replaced. For your safety,  
tires that are damaged or show signs of excessive wear should not be  
used because they are more likely to blow out or fail.  
142  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Improper or inadequate vehicle maintenance can cause tires to wear  
abnormally. Inspect all your tires, including the spare, frequently, and  
replace them if one or more of the following conditions exist:  
Tire wear  
When the tread is worn down to  
1/16th of an inch (2 mm), tires must  
be replaced to help prevent your  
vehicle from skidding and  
hydroplaning. Built-in treadwear  
indicators, or “wear bars”, which  
look like narrow strips of smooth  
rubber across the tread will appear  
on the tire when the tread is worn  
down to 1/16th of an inch (2 mm).  
When the tire tread wears down to  
the same height as these “wear bars”, the tire is worn out and must be  
replaced.  
Damage  
Periodically inspect the tire treads and sidewalls for damage (such as  
bulges in the tread or sidewalls, cracks in the tread groove and  
separation in the tread or sidewall). If damage is observed or suspected  
have the tire inspected by a tire professional. Tires can be damaged  
during off-road use, so inspection after off-road use is also  
recommended.  
WARNING: Age  
Tires degrade over time depending on many factors such as  
weather, storage conditions, and conditions of use (load, speed,  
inflation pressure, etc.) the tires experience throughout their lives.  
In general, tires should be replaced after six years regardless of tread  
wear. However, heat caused by hot climates or frequent high loading  
conditions can accelerate the aging process and may require tires to be  
replaced more frequently.  
You should replace your spare tire when you replace the road tires or  
after six years due to aging even if it has not been used.  
143  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN)  
Both U.S. and Canada Federal regulations require tire manufacturers to  
place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This  
information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of  
the tire and also provides a U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number for  
safety standard certification and in case of a recall.  
This begins with the letters “DOT” and indicates that the tire meets all  
federal standards. The next two numbers or letters are the plant code  
designating where it was manufactured, the next two are the tire size  
code and the last four numbers represent the week and year the tire was  
built. For example, the numbers 317 mean the 31st week of 1997. After  
2000 the numbers go to four digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th  
week of 2001. The numbers in between are identification codes used for  
traceability. This information is used to contact customers if a tire defect  
requires a recall.  
Tire Replacement Requirements  
Your vehicle is equipped with tires designed to provide a safe ride and  
handling capability.  
WARNING: Only use replacement tires and wheels that are the  
same size, load index, speed rating and type (such as P-metric  
versus LT-metric or all-season versus all-terrain) as those originally  
provided by Ford. The recommended tire and wheel size may be found  
on either the Safety Compliance Certification Label or the Tire Label  
which is located on the B-Pillar or edge of the driver’s door. If this  
information is not found on these labels then you should contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible. Use of any tire or wheel not  
recommended by Ford can affect the safety and performance of your  
vehicle, which could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle  
control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death. Additionally the use  
of non-recommended tires and wheels could cause steering,  
suspension, axle or transfer case/power transfer unit failure. If you  
have questions regarding tire replacement, contact your authorized  
dealer as soon as possible.  
144  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: When mounting replacement tires and wheels, you  
should not exceed the maximum pressure indicated on the  
sidewall of the tire to set the beads without additional precautions  
listed below. If the beads do not seat at the maximum pressure  
indicated, re-lubricate and try again.  
When inflating the tire for mounting pressures up to 20 psi greater  
than the maximum pressure on the tire sidewall, the following  
precautions must be taken to protect the person mounting the tire:  
1. Make sure that you have the correct tire and wheel size.  
2. Lubricate the tire bead and wheel bead seat area again.  
3. Stand at a minimum of 12 ft. (3.66 m) away from the tire wheel  
assembly.  
4. Use both eye and ear protection.  
For a mounting pressure more than 20 psi greater than the maximum  
pressure, a Ford Dealer or other tire service professional should do the  
mounting.  
Always inflate steel carcass tires with a remote air fill with the person  
inflating standing at a minimum of 12 ft. (3.66 m) away from the tire  
wheel assembly.  
Important: Remember to replace the wheel valve stems when the road  
tires are replaced on your vehicle.  
It is recommended that the two front tires or two rear tires generally be  
replaced as a pair.  
The tire pressure sensors mounted in the wheels (if equipped) are not  
designed to be used in aftermarket wheels.  
The use of wheels or tires not recommended by Ford Motor Company  
may affect the operation of your Tire Pressure Monitoring System (if  
equipped).  
If the TPMS indicator is flashing, your TPMS is malfunctioning. Your  
replacement tire might be incompatible with your TPMS, or some  
component of the TPMS may be damaged (if equipped).  
Safety practices  
Driving habits have a great deal to do with your tire mileage and safety.  
Observe posted speed limits  
Avoid fast starts, stops and turns  
Avoid potholes and objects on the road  
Do not run over curbs or hit the tire against a curb when parking  
145  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: If your vehicle is stuck in snow, mud, sand, etc., do  
not rapidly spin the tires; spinning the tires can tear the tire and  
cause an explosion. A tire can explode in as little as three to five  
seconds.  
WARNING: Do not spin the wheels at over 35 mph (56 km/h).  
The tires may fail and injure a passenger or bystander.  
Highway hazards  
No matter how carefully you drive there’s always the possibility that you  
may eventually have a flat tire on the highway. Drive slowly to the  
closest safe area out of traffic. This may further damage the flat tire, but  
your safety is more important.  
If you feel a sudden vibration or ride disturbance while driving, or you  
suspect your tire or vehicle has been damaged, immediately reduce your  
speed. Drive with caution until you can safely pull off the road. Stop and  
inspect the tires for damage. If a tire is under-inflated or damaged,  
deflate it, remove wheel and replace it with your spare tire and wheel. If  
you cannot detect a cause, have the vehicle towed to the nearest repair  
facility or tire dealer to have the vehicle inspected.  
Tire and wheel alignment  
A bad jolt from hitting a curb or pothole can cause the front end of your  
vehicle to become misaligned or cause damage to your tires. If your  
vehicle seems to pull to one side when you’re driving, the wheels may be  
out of alignment. Have an authorized dealer check the wheel alignment  
periodically.  
Wheel misalignment in the front or the rear can cause uneven and rapid  
treadwear of your tires and should be corrected by an authorized dealer.  
Front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles and those with an independent rear  
suspension (if equipped) may require alignment of all four wheels.  
The tires should also be balanced periodically. An unbalanced tire and  
wheel assembly may result in irregular tire wear.  
Tire rotation  
Rotating your tires at the recommended interval (as indicated in the  
scheduled maintenance information that comes with your vehicle) will  
help your tires wear more evenly, providing better tire performance and  
longer tire life.  
146  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Front Wheel Drive (FWD)  
vehicles (front tires at top of  
diagram)  
Sometimes irregular tire wear can be corrected by rotating the tires.  
Note: If your tires show uneven wear ask an authorized dealer to check  
for and correct any wheel misalignment, tire imbalance or mechanical  
problem involved before tire rotation.  
Note: Your vehicle may be equipped with a dissimilar spare tire/wheel. A  
dissimilar spare tire/wheel is defined as a spare tire and/or wheel that is  
different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires and wheels. If  
you have a dissimilar spare tire/wheel it is intended for temporary use  
only and should not be used in a tire rotation.  
Note: After having your tires rotated, inflation pressure must be checked  
and adjusted to the vehicle requirements.  
INFORMATION CONTAINED ON THE TIRE SIDEWALL  
Both U.S. and Canada Federal regulations require tire manufacturers to  
place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This  
information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of  
the tire and also provides a U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number for  
safety standard certification and in case of a recall.  
147  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Information on “P” type tires  
P215/65R15 95H is an example of a  
tire size, load index and speed  
rating. The definitions of these  
items are listed below. (Note that  
the tire size, load index and speed  
rating for your vehicle may be  
different from this example.)  
1. P: Indicates a tire, designated by  
the Tire and Rim Association  
(T&RA), that may be used for  
service on cars, SUVs, minivans and  
light trucks.  
Note: If your tire size does not  
begin with a letter this may mean it  
is designated by either ETRTO  
(European Tire and Rim Technical Organization) or JATMA (Japan Tire  
Manufacturing Association).  
2. 215: Indicates the nominal width of the tire in millimeters from  
sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger the number, the  
wider the tire.  
3. 65: Indicates the aspect ratio which gives the tire’s ratio of height to  
width.  
4. R: Indicates a “radial” type tire.  
5. 15: Indicates the wheel or rim diameter in inches. If you change your  
wheel size, you will have to purchase new tires to match the new wheel  
diameter.  
6. 95: Indicates the tire’s load index. It is an index that relates to how  
much weight a tire can carry. You may find this information in your  
Owner’s Guide. If not, contact a local tire dealer.  
Note: You may not find this information on all tires because it is not  
required by federal law.  
7. H: Indicates the tire’s speed rating. The speed rating denotes the  
speed at which a tire is designed to be driven for extended periods of  
time under a standard condition of load and inflation pressure. The tires  
on your vehicle may operate at different conditions for load and inflation  
pressure. These speed ratings may need to be adjusted for the difference  
in conditions. The ratings range from 81 mph (130 km/h) to 186 mph  
(299 km/h). These ratings are listed in the following chart.  
148  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Note: You may not find this information on all tires because it is not  
required by federal law.  
Letter rating  
Speed rating - mph (km/h)  
81 mph (130 km/h)  
87 mph (140 km/h)  
99 mph (159 km/h)  
106 mph (171 km/h)  
112 mph (180 km/h)  
118 mph (190 km/h)  
124 mph (200 km/h)  
130 mph (210 km/h)  
149 mph (240 km/h)  
168 mph (270 km/h)  
186 mph (299 km/h)  
M
N
Q
R
S
T
U
H
V
W
Y
Note: For tires with a maximum speed capability over 149 mph  
(240 km/h), tire manufacturers sometimes use the letters ZR. For  
those with a maximum speed capability over 186 mph (299 km/h), tire  
manufacturers always use the letters ZR.  
8. U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN): This begins with the  
letters “DOT” and indicates that the tire meets all federal standards. The  
next two numbers or letters are the plant code designating where it was  
manufactured, the next two are the tire size code and the last four  
numbers represent the week and year the tire was built. For example,  
the numbers 317 mean the 31st week of 1997. After 2000 the numbers  
go to four digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th week of 2001. The  
numbers in between are identification codes used for traceability. This  
information is used to contact customers if a tire defect requires a recall.  
9. M+S or M/S: Mud and Snow, or  
AT: All Terrain, or  
AS: All Season.  
10. Tire Ply Composition and Material Used: Indicates the number of  
plies or the number of layers of rubber-coated fabric in the tire tread and  
sidewall. Tire manufacturers also must indicate the ply materials in the  
tire and the sidewall, which include steel, nylon, polyester, and others.  
11. Maximum Load: Indicates the maximum load in kilograms and  
pounds that can be carried by the tire. Refer to the Safety Compliance  
Certification Label, which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the  
driver’s door, for the correct tire pressure for your vehicle.  
149  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
12. Treadwear, Traction and Temperature Grades  
Treadwear: The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the  
wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a  
specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150  
would wear one and one-half (112) times as well on the government  
course as a tire graded 100.  
Traction: The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B,  
and C. The grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement  
as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test  
surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor  
traction performance.  
Temperature: The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C,  
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its  
ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a  
specified indoor laboratory test wheel.  
13. Maximum Permissible Inflation Pressure: Indicates the tire  
manufacturers’ maximum permissible pressure and/or the pressure at  
which the maximum load can be carried by the tire. This pressure is  
normally higher than the manufacturer’s recommended cold inflation  
pressure which can be found on the Safety Compliance Certification  
Label or Tire Label which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the  
driver’s door. The cold inflation pressure should never be set lower than  
the recommended pressure on the vehicle label.  
The tire suppliers may have additional markings, notes or warnings such  
as standard load, radial tubeless, etc.  
150  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Additional information contained on the tire sidewall for “LT” type  
tires  
“LT” type tires have some additional  
information beyond those of “P”  
type tires; these differences are  
described below.  
Note: Tire Quality Grades do not  
apply to this type of tire.  
1. LT: Indicates a tire, designated by  
the Tire and Rim Association  
(T&RA), that is intended for service  
on light trucks.  
2. Load Range/Load Inflation  
Limits: Indicates the tire’s  
load-carrying capabilities and its  
inflation limits.  
3. Maximum Load Dual lb. (kg) at psi (kPa) cold: Indicates the  
maximum load and tire pressure when the tire is used as a dual; defined  
as four tires on the rear axle (a total of six or more tires on the vehicle).  
4. Maximum Load Single lb. (kg) at psi (kPa) cold: Indicates the  
maximum load and tire pressure when the tire is used as a single;  
defined as two tires (total) on the rear axle.  
151  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Information on “T” type tires  
“T” type tires have some additional  
information beyond those of “P”  
type tires; these differences are  
described below:  
T145/80D16 is an example of a tire  
size.  
Note: The temporary tire size for  
your vehicle may be different from  
this example. Tire Quality Grades do  
not apply to this type of tire.  
1. T: Indicates a type of tire,  
designated by the Tire and Rim  
Association (T&RA), that is  
intended for temporary service on  
cars, SUVs, minivans and light  
trucks.  
2. 145: Indicates the nominal width  
of the tire in millimeters from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general,  
the larger the number, the wider the tire.  
3. 80: Indicates the aspect ratio which gives the tire’s ratio of height to  
width. Numbers of 70 or lower indicate a short sidewall.  
4. D: Indicates a “diagonal” type tire.  
R: Indicates a “radial” type tire.  
5. 16: Indicates the wheel or rim diameter in inches. If you change your  
wheel size, you will have to purchase new tires to match the new wheel  
diameter.  
Location of the tire label  
You will find a Tire Label containing tire inflation pressure by tire size  
and other important information located on the B-Pillar or the edge of  
the driver’s door.  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)  
Each tire, including the spare (if  
provided), should be checked  
monthly when cold and inflated to  
the inflation pressure recommended  
by the vehicle manufacturer on the  
152  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires  
of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire  
inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation  
pressure for those tires.)  
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire  
pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure  
telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.  
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should  
stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the  
proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the  
tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces  
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling  
and stopping ability.  
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire  
maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain correct tire  
pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger  
illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.  
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator  
to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS  
malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale.  
When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for  
approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated.  
This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as  
the malfunction exists.  
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be  
able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions  
may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of  
replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the  
TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction  
telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to  
ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the  
TPMS to continue to function properly.  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System complies with part 15 of the FCC  
rules and with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful  
interference, and (2) This device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
WARNING: The Tire Pressure Monitoring System is NOT a  
substitute for manually checking tire pressure. The tire pressure  
should be checked periodically (at least monthly) using a tire gauge,  
see Inflating your tires in this chapter. Failure to properly maintain  
your tire pressure could increase the risk of tire failure, loss of control,  
vehicle rollover and personal injury.  
153  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Changing tires with TPMS  
Each road tire is equipped with  
a tire pressure sensor fastened  
to the inside rim of the wheel.  
The pressure sensor is covered  
by the tire and is not visible  
unless the tire is removed. The  
pressure sensor is located  
opposite (180 degrees) from the  
valve stem. Care must be taken  
when changing the tire to avoid  
damaging the sensor. It is  
recommended that you always have  
your tires serviced by an authorized  
dealer.  
The tire pressure should be checked  
periodically (at least monthly) using  
an accurate tire gauge, refer to  
Inflating your tires in this chapter.  
Understanding your Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System measures pressure in your four  
road tires and sends the tire pressure readings to your vehicle. The Low  
Tire Pressure Warning Lamp will turn ON if the tire pressure is  
significantly low. Once the light is illuminated, your tires are under  
inflated and need to be inflated to the manufacturer’s recommended tire  
pressure. Even if the light turns ON and a short time later turns OFF,  
your tire pressure still needs to be checked. Visit www.checkmytires.org  
for additional information.  
When your temporary spare tire is installed  
When one of your road tires needs to be replaced with the temporary  
spare, the TPMS system will continue to identify an issue to remind you  
that the damaged road wheel/tire needs to be repaired and put back on  
your vehicle.  
To restore the full functionality of the Tire Pressure Monitoring System,  
have the damaged road wheel/tire repaired and remounted on your  
vehicle. For additional information, refer to Changing tires with TPMS  
in this section.  
154  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
When you believe your system is not operating properly  
The main function of the Tire Pressure Monitoring System is to warn you  
when your tires need air. It can also warn you in the event the system is  
no longer capable of functioning as intended. Please refer to the  
following chart for information concerning your Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System:  
Low Tire  
Pressure  
Warning  
Light  
Possible  
cause  
Customer Action Required  
Solid Warning Tire(s)  
1. Check your tire pressure to ensure  
tires are properly inflated; refer to In-  
flating your tires in this chapter.  
Light  
under-  
inflated  
2. After inflating your tires to the manu-  
facturer’s recommended inflation pres-  
sure as shown on the Tire Label (located  
on the edge of driver’s door or the  
B-Pillar), the vehicle must be driven for  
at least two minutes over 20 mph  
(32 km/h) before the light will turn OFF.  
Spare tire in Your temporary spare tire is in use. Re-  
use  
pair the damaged road wheel/tire and  
reinstall it on the vehicle to restore sys-  
tem functionality. For a description on  
how the system functions, refer to When  
your temporary spare tire is installed  
in this section.  
TPMS mal-  
function  
If your tires are properly inflated and  
your spare tire is not in use and the light  
remains ON, contact your authorized  
dealer as soon as possible.  
155  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Low Tire  
Pressure  
Warning  
Light  
Possible  
cause  
Customer Action Required  
Flashing  
Warning  
Light  
Spare tire in Your temporary spare tire is in use. Re-  
use  
pair the damaged road wheel and re-  
mount it on the vehicle to restore system  
functionality. For a description of how  
the system functions under these condi-  
tions, refer to When your temporary  
spare tire is installed in this section.  
If your tires are properly inflated and  
your spare tire is not in use and the  
TPMS warning light still flashes, contact  
your authorized dealer as soon as pos-  
sible.  
TPMS mal-  
function  
When inflating your tires  
When putting air into your tires (such as at a gas station or in your  
garage), the Tire Pressure Monitoring System may not respond  
immediately to the air added to your tires.  
It may take up to two minutes of driving over 20 mph (32 km/h) for the  
light to turn OFF after you have filled your tires to the recommended  
inflation pressure.  
How temperature affects your tire pressure  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) monitors tire pressure in  
each pneumatic tire. While driving in a normal manner, a typical  
passenger tire inflation pressure may increase approximately 2 to 4 psi  
(14 to 28 kPa) from a cold start situation. If the vehicle is stationary  
over night with the outside temperature significantly lower than the  
daytime temperature, the tire pressure may decrease approximately 3 psi  
(20.7 kPa) for a drop of 30° F (16.6°C) in ambient temperature. This  
lower pressure value may be detected by the TPMS as being significantly  
lower than the recommended inflation pressure and activate the TPMS  
warning for low tire pressure. If the low tire pressure warning light is  
ON, visually check each tire to verify that no tire is flat. (If one or more  
tires are flat, repair as necessary.) Check air pressure in the road tires. If  
any tire is under-inflated, carefully drive the vehicle to the nearest  
location where air can be added to the tires. Inflate all the tires to the  
recommended inflation pressure.  
156  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
SNOW TIRES AND CHAINS  
WARNING: Snow tires must be the same size, load index, speed  
rating as those originally provided by Ford. Use of any tire or  
wheel not recommended by Ford can affect the safety and  
performance of your vehicle, which could result in an increased risk of  
loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
Additionally, the use of non-recommended tires and wheels could  
cause steering, suspension, axle or transfer case/power transfer unit  
failure.  
The original equipment tires on your vehicle have an all-weather tread  
design to provide traction, handling and braking performance in  
year-round driving. You may install snow tires for improved traction  
when driving in areas with sustained periods of snow or icy driving  
conditions.  
If you choose to install snow tires on your vehicle, they must be the  
same size, construction, and load range as the original tires listed on the  
tire placard, and they must be installed on all four wheels. Mixing tires of  
different size or construction on your vehicle can adversely affect your  
vehicle’s handling and braking, and may lead to loss of vehicle control.  
WARNING: Do not use snow chains or cables on this vehicle as  
they may cause damage to your vehicle which may lead to loss  
of vehicle control.  
VEHICLE LOADING – WITH AND WITHOUT A TRAILER  
This section will guide you in the proper loading of your vehicle and/or  
trailer, to keep your loaded vehicle weight within its design rating  
capability, with or without a trailer. Properly loading your vehicle will  
provide maximum return of vehicle design performance. Before loading  
your vehicle, familiarize yourself with the following terms for determining  
your vehicle’s weight ratings, with or without a trailer, from the vehicle’s  
Safety Compliance Certification Label:  
Base Curb Weight – is the weight of the vehicle including a full tank of  
fuel and all standard equipment. It does not include passengers, cargo, or  
optional equipment.  
Vehicle Curb Weight – is the weight of your new vehicle when you  
picked it up from your authorized dealer plus any aftermarket  
equipment.  
157  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Cargo Weight – includes all weight added to the Base Curb Weight,  
including cargo and optional equipment. When towing, trailer tongue load  
weight is also part of cargo weight.  
GAW (Gross Axle Weight) – is the total weight placed on each axle  
(front and rear) – including vehicle curb weight and all payload.  
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) – is the maximum allowable  
weight that can be carried by a single axle (front or rear). These  
numbers are shown on the Safety Compliance Certification Label  
located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. The total  
load on each axle must never exceed its GAWR.  
Note: For trailer towing information refer to Trailer towing found in  
this chapter or the RV and Trailer Towing Guide provided by your  
authorized dealer.  
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) – is the Vehicle Curb Weight + cargo +  
passengers.  
158  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight  
Rating) – is the maximum  
allowable weight of the fully loaded  
vehicle (including all options,  
equipment, passengers and cargo).  
The GVWR is shown on the  
Safety Compliance Certification  
Label located on the B-Pillar or  
the edge of the driver’s door.  
The GVW must never exceed the  
GVWR.  
WARNING: Exceeding the Safety Compliance Certification Label  
vehicle weight rating limits could result in substandard vehicle  
handling or performance, engine, transmission and/or structural  
damage, serious damage to the vehicle, loss of control and personal  
injury.  
GCW (Gross Combined Weight) – is the weight of the loaded vehicle  
(GVW) plus the weight of the fully loaded trailer.  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating) – is the maximum allowable  
weight of the vehicle and the loaded trailer – including all cargo and  
passengers – that the vehicle can handle without risking damage.  
(Important: The towing vehicles’ braking system is rated for operation at  
GVWR, not at GCWR. Separate functional brakes should be used for safe  
control of towed vehicles and for trailers where the GCW of the towing  
vehicle plus the trailer exceed the GVWR of the towing vehicle. The  
GCW must never exceed the GCWR.  
159  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Maximum Loaded Trailer Weight – is the highest possible weight of a  
fully loaded trailer the vehicle can tow. It assumes a vehicle with only  
mandatory options, no cargo (internal or external), a tongue load of  
10–15% (conventional trailer), and driver only (150 lb. [68 kg]). Consult  
your authorized dealer (or the RV and Trailer Towing Guide  
provided by your authorized dealer) for more detailed  
information.  
WARNING: Do not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on  
the Safety Compliance Certification Label.  
WARNING: Do not use replacement tires with lower load  
carrying capacities than the original tires because they may  
lower the vehicle’s GVWR and GAWR limitations. Replacement tires  
with a higher limit than the original tires do not increase the GVWR  
and GAWR limitations.  
WARNING: Exceeding any vehicle weight rating limitation could  
result in serious damage to the vehicle and/or personal injury.  
Steps for determining the correct load limit:  
1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and cargo  
should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs.” on your vehicle’s placard.  
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will  
be riding in your vehicle.  
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX  
kg or XXX lbs.  
4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage  
load capacity. For example, if the “XXX” amount equals 1,400 lbs. and  
there will be five 150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the amount of  
available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs. (1400–750 (5 x 150)  
= 650 lb.). In metric units (635–340 (5 x 68) = 295 kg.)  
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on  
the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and  
luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4.  
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be  
transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this  
reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.  
160  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
The following gives you a few examples on how to calculate the available  
amount of cargo and luggage load capacity:  
Another example for your vehicle with 1400 lb. (635 kg) of cargo and  
luggage capacity. You decide to go golfing. Is there enough load  
capacity to carry you, 4 of your friends and all the golf bags? You and  
four friends average 220 lb. (99 kg) each and the golf bags weigh  
approximately 30 lb. (13.5 kg) each. The calculation would be: 1400 -  
(5 x 220) - (5 x 30) = 1400 - 1100 - 150 = 150 lb. Yes, you have  
enough load capacity in your vehicle to transport four friends and  
your golf bags. In metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kg - (5 x  
99 kg) - (5 x 13.5 kg) = 635 - 495 - 67.5 = 72.5 kg.  
A final example for your vehicle with 1400 lb. (635 kg) of cargo and  
luggage capacity. You and one of your friends decide to pick up  
cement from the local home improvement store to finish that patio  
you have been planning for the past 2 years. Measuring the inside of  
the vehicle with the rear seat folded down, you have room for  
12-100 lb. (45 kg) bags of cement. Do you have enough load capacity  
to transport the cement to your home? If you and your friend each  
weigh 220 lb. (99 kg), the calculation would be: 1400 - (2 x 220) - (12  
x 100) = 1400 - 440 - 1200 = - 240 lb. No, you do not have enough  
cargo capacity to carry that much weight. In metric units, the  
calculation would be: 635 kg - (2 x 99 kg) - (12 x 45 kg) = 635 - 198 -  
540 = -103 kg. You will need to reduce the load weight by at least  
240 lb. (104 kg). If you remove 3-100 lb. (45 kg) cement bags, then  
the load calculation would be:  
1400 - (2 x 220) - (9 x 100) = 1400 - 440 - 900 = 60 lb. Now you have  
the load capacity to transport the cement and your friend home. In  
metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kg - (2 x 99 kg) - (9 x  
45 kg) = 635 - 198 - 405 = 32 kg.  
The above calculations also assume that the loads are positioned in your  
vehicle in a manner that does not overload the Front or the Rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating specified for your vehicle on the Safety Compliance  
Certification Label found on the edge of the driver’s door.  
TRAILER TOWING  
WARNING: Never tow a trailer with this vehicle. Your vehicle is  
not equipped to tow. No towing packages are available through  
an authorized dealer.  
161  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
RECREATIONAL TOWING  
Follow these guidelines if you have a need for recreational (RV) towing.  
An example of recreational towing would be towing your vehicle behind  
a motorhome. These guidelines are designed to ensure that your  
transmission is not damaged.  
Note: Put your climate control system in recirculated air mode to  
prevent exhaust fumes from entering the vehicle. Refer to the Climate  
controls chapter for more information.  
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) vehicles with manual transmissions: If  
your vehicle is equipped with a manual transmission, shifting the  
transmission into neutral (N) permits “flat-towing” (all wheels on the  
ground) for pulling behind a motorhome.  
Before you tow your vehicle:  
Release the parking brake.  
Move the gearshift to the neutral position.  
Turn the key in the ignition to the off position.  
The maximum recommended speed is 70 mph (113 km/h).  
The maximum recommended distance is unlimited.  
The vehicle must be towed in the forward position to ensure no  
damage is done to the internal transmission components.  
In addition, it is recommended that you follow the instructions provided  
by the aftermarket manufacturer of the towing equipment, if provided.  
In case of a roadside emergency with a disabled vehicle, see Wrecker  
towing in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
Front Wheel Drive (FWD) vehicles with automatic transmissions:  
Do not tow the vehicle with the front drive wheels on the ground. It is  
recommended to tow your vehicle with the front drive wheels on a dolly  
or with all four (4) wheels off the ground on a car-hauling trailer.  
In case of a roadside emergency with a disabled vehicle, see Wrecker  
towing in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
162  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
STARTING  
Positions of the ignition  
1. Off — locks the steering wheel,  
automatic transmission gearshift  
lever and allows key removal. This  
position also shuts the engine and  
all electrical accessories off.  
2. Accessory—allows the electrical  
accessories such as the radio to  
operate while the engine is not  
running.  
3. On— all electrical circuits operational. Warning lights illuminated. Key  
position when driving.  
4. Start— cranks the engine. Release the key as soon as the engine  
starts.  
Preparing to start your vehicle  
Engine starting is controlled by the powertrain control system.  
This system meets all Canadian Interference-Causing Equipment  
standard requirements regulating the impulse electrical field strength of  
radio noise.  
When starting a fuel-injected engine, don’t press the accelerator before  
or during starting. Only use the accelerator when you have difficulty  
starting the engine. For more information on starting the vehicle, refer to  
Starting the engine in this chapter.  
WARNING: Extended idling at high engine speeds can produce  
very high temperatures in the engine and exhaust system,  
creating the risk of fire or other damage.  
WARNING: Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle in dry grass  
or other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up the  
engine compartment and exhaust system, which can start a fire.  
WARNING: Do not start your vehicle in a closed garage or in  
other enclosed areas. Exhaust fumes can be toxic. Always open  
the garage door before you start the engine. See Guarding against  
exhaust fumes in this chapter for more instructions.  
163  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have  
your dealer inspect your vehicle immediately. Do not drive if you  
smell exhaust fumes.  
Important safety precautions  
When the engine starts, the idle RPM runs faster to warm the engine. If  
the engine idle speed does not slow down automatically, have the vehicle  
checked.  
Before starting the vehicle:  
1. Make sure all occupants buckle their safety belts. For more  
information on safety belts and their proper usage, refer to the Seating  
and Safety Restraints chapter.  
2. Make sure the headlamps and electrical accessories are off.  
If starting a vehicle with an automatic transaxle:  
Make sure the parking brake is  
set.  
164  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Make sure the gearshift is in P  
(Park).  
If starting a vehicle with a manual  
transmission:  
1. Make sure the parking brake is  
set.  
2. Push the clutch pedal to the floor.  
Turn the key to 3 (on) without  
turning the key to 4 (start).  
Some warning lights will briefly illuminate. See Warning lights and  
chimes in the Instrument Cluster chapter for more information  
regarding the warning lights.  
165  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Starting the engine  
1. Turn the key to 3 (on) without  
turning the key to 4 (start).  
2. Turn the key to 4 (start), then  
release the key as soon as the  
engine begins cranking. Your vehicle  
has a computer assisted cranking  
system that assists in starting the  
engine. After releasing the key from  
the 4 (start) position, the engine may continue cranking for up to  
10 seconds or until the vehicle starts.  
Note: Cranking may be stopped at any time by turning the key to the off  
position.  
3. After idling for a few seconds, apply the brake, shift into gear and  
drive.  
Note: If the engine does not start on the first try, turn the key to the off  
position, wait 10 seconds and try Step 2 again. If the engine still fails to  
start, press the accelerator to the floor and try Step 2 again, keeping the  
accelerator on the floor until the engine begins to accelerate above  
cranking speeds; this will allow the engine to crank with the fuel shut off  
in case the engine is flooded with fuel.  
Guarding against exhaust fumes  
Carbon monoxide is present in exhaust fumes. Take precautions to avoid  
its dangerous effects.  
WARNING: If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have  
your dealer inspect your vehicle immediately. Do not drive if you  
smell exhaust fumes.  
Important ventilating information  
If the engine is idling while the vehicle is stopped for a long period of  
time, open the windows at least one inch (2.5 cm) or adjust the heating  
or air conditioning to bring in fresh air.  
166  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER (IF EQUIPPED)  
An engine block heater warms the engine coolant which aids in starting  
and allows the heater/defroster system to respond quickly. If your vehicle  
is equipped with this system, your equipment includes a heater element  
which is installed in your engine block and a wire harness which allows  
the user to connect the system to a grounded 120 volt a/c electrical  
source. The block heater system is most effective when outdoor  
temperatures reach below 0°F (-18°C).  
WARNING: Failure to follow engine block heater instructions  
could result in property damage or physical injury.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of electrical shock, do not use  
your heater with ungrounded electrical systems or two-pronged  
(cheater) adapters.  
Prior to using the engine block heater, follow these recommendations for  
proper and safe operation:  
For your safety, use an outdoor extension cord that is product  
certified by Underwriter’s Laboratory (UL) or Canadian Standards  
Association (CSA). Use only an extension cord that can be used  
outdoors, in cold temperatures, and is clearly marked ЉSuitable for Use  
with Outdoor Appliances.Љ Never use an indoor extension cord  
outdoors; it could result in an electric shock or fire hazard.  
Use a 16 gauge outdoor extension cord, minimum.  
Use as short an extension cord as possible.  
Do not use multiple extension cords. Instead, use one extension cord  
which is long enough to reach from the engine block heater cord to  
the outlet without stretching.  
Make certain that the extension cord is in excellent condition (not  
patched or spliced). Store your extension cord indoors at  
temperatures above 32°F (0°C). Outdoor conditions can deteriorate  
extension cords over a period of time.  
To reduce the risk of electrical shock, do not use your heater with  
ungrounded electrical systems or two pronged (cheater) adapters.  
Also ensure that the block heater, especially the cord, is in good  
condition before use.  
Make sure that when in operation, the extension cord plug /engine  
block heater cord plug connection is free and clear of water in order  
to prevent possible shock or fire.  
167  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Be sure that areas where the vehicle is parked are clean and clear of  
all combustibles such as petroleum products, dust, rags, paper and  
similar items.  
Be sure that the engine block heater, heater cord and extension cord  
are solidly connected. A poor connection can cause the cord to  
become very hot and may result in an electrical shock or fire. Be sure  
to check for heat anywhere in the electrical hookup once the system  
has been operating for approximately a half hour.  
Finally, have the engine block heater system checked during your fall  
tune-up to be sure it’s in good working order.  
How to use the engine block heater  
Ensure the receptacle terminals are clean and dry prior to use. To clean  
them, use a dry cloth.  
Depending on the type of factory installed equipment, your engine block  
heater will use .4 to 1.0 kilowatt-hours of energy per hour of use. Your  
factory installed block heater system does not have a thermostat;  
however, maximum temperature is attained after approximately three  
hours of operation. Block heater operation longer than three hours will  
not improve system performance and will unnecessarily use additional  
electricity.  
Make sure system is unplugged and properly stowed before driving the  
vehicle. While not in use, make sure the protective cover seals the  
prongs of the engine block heater cord plug.  
BRAKES  
Occasional brake noise is normal. If a metal-to-metal, continuous grinding  
or continuous squeal sound is present, the brake linings may be worn-out  
and should be inspected by an authorized dealer. If the vehicle has  
continuous vibration or shudder in the steering wheel while braking, the  
vehicle should be inspected by an authorized dealer.  
Refer to Brake system warning  
!
P
light in the Instrument Cluster  
chapter for information on the brake  
system warning light.  
BRAKE  
168  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Under normal operating conditions, brake dust may accumulate on the  
wheels. Some brake dust is inevitable as brakes wear and does not  
contribute to brake noise. The use of modern friction materials with  
emphasis on improved performance and environmental considerations  
can lead to more dust than in the past. Brake dust can be cleaned by  
weekly washing with soapy water and a soft sponge. Heavier deposits can  
be removed with Motorcraft Wheel and Tire Cleaner (ZC-37–A).  
Four-wheel anti-lock brake system (ABS) (if equipped)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with an Anti-lock Braking System (ABS).  
This system helps you maintain steering control during emergency stops  
by keeping the brakes from locking. Noise from the ABS pump motor  
and brake pedal pulsation may be observed during ABS braking; any  
pulsation or mechanical noise you may feel or hear is normal.  
Using ABS  
When hard braking is required, apply continuous force on the brake  
pedal; do not pump the brake pedal since this will reduce the  
effectiveness of the ABS and will increase your vehicle’s stopping  
distance. The ABS will be activated immediately, allowing you to retain  
steering control during hard braking and on slippery surfaces. However,  
the ABS does not decrease stopping distance.  
ABS warning lamp  
The ABS lamp in the instrument  
cluster momentarily illuminates  
ABS  
when the ignition is turned on. If  
the light does not illuminate during  
start up, remains on or flashes, the  
ABS may be disabled and may need to be serviced.  
Even when the ABS is disabled,  
normal braking is still effective. (If  
your BRAKE warning lamp  
illuminates with the parking brake  
released, have your brake system  
serviced immediately.)  
!
P
BRAKE  
169  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Parking brake  
To set the parking brake (1), pull  
the parking brake handle up as far  
as possible.  
The BRAKE warning lamp will  
illuminate and will remain  
illuminated until the parking brake  
is released.  
!
P
BRAKE  
To release, press and hold the button (2), pull the handle up slightly,  
then push the handle down.  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
that the gearshift is securely latched in P (Park) (automatic  
transmission) or in 1 (First) (manual transmission).  
WARNING: If the parking brake is fully released, but the brake  
warning lamp remains illuminated, the brakes may not be  
working properly. See your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
TRACTION CONTROL™ (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a Traction Control™ system. This  
system helps you maintain the stability and steerability of your vehicle,  
especially on slippery road surfaces such as snow- or ice-covered roads  
and gravel roads. The system will allow your vehicle to make better use  
of available traction in these conditions.  
170  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: Aggressive driving in any road conditions can cause  
you to lose control of your vehicle increasing the risk of severe  
personal injury or property damage. The occurrence of a Traction  
Control™ event is an indication that at least some of the tires have  
exceeded their ability to grip the road; this may lead to an increased  
risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and  
death. If you experience a severe road event, SLOW DOWN.  
During Traction Control™ operation,  
the traction control active light will  
illuminate, you may hear an electric  
motor type of sound coming from  
the engine compartment and the  
engine will not “rev-up” when you  
push further on the accelerator. This is normal system behavior and  
should be no reason for concern.  
The Traction Control™ switch is  
located on the instrument panel.  
The Traction Control™ system will  
automatically turn on every time the  
ignition is turned off and on.  
If you should become stuck in snow  
or ice or on a very slippery road  
surface, try switching the Traction Control™ system off by pressing the  
switch. This may allow excess wheel spin to “dig” the vehicle out and  
enable a successful “rocking” maneuver. If you want to turn off the  
Traction Control™ system be aware that, for safety reasons, the switch  
must be pressed and held for at least one second before the system is  
turned off. To re-engage the Traction Control™ system, the button must  
again be held for at least one second.  
If a system fault is detected, the traction control active light will  
illuminate, the Traction Control™ button will not turn the system on or  
off and your vehicle should be serviced by an authorized dealer.  
171  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
ADVANCETRACSTABILITY ENHANCEMENT SYSTEM  
(IF EQUIPPED)  
WARNING: Vehicle modifications involving braking system,  
aftermarket roof racks, suspension, steering system, tire  
construction and/or wheel/tire size may change the handling  
characteristics of the vehicle and may adversely affect the performance  
of the AdvanceTracsystem. In addition, installing any stereo  
loudspeakers may interfere with and adversely affect the AdvanceTrac௡  
system. Install any aftermarket stereo loudspeaker as far as possible  
from the front center console, the tunnel, and the front seats in order  
to minimize the risk of interfering with the AdvanceTracsensors.  
Reducing the effectiveness of the AdvanceTracsystem could lead to  
an increased risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal  
injury and death.  
WARNING: Remember that even advanced technology cannot  
defy the laws of physics. It’s always possible to lose control of a  
vehicle due to inappropriate driver input for the conditions. Aggressive  
driving on any road condition can cause you to lose control of your  
vehicle increasing the risk of personal injury or property damage.  
Activation of the AdvanceTracsystem is an indication that at least  
some of the tires have exceeded their ability to grip the road; this  
could reduce the operator’s ability to control the vehicle potentially  
resulting in a loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury  
and death. If your AdvanceTracsystem activates, SLOW DOWN.  
WARNING: If a failure has been detected within the  
AdvanceTracsystem, the Љsliding carЉ icon  
will illuminate  
steadily. Verify that the AdvanceTracsystem is not manually disabled  
(push the AdvanceTrac“Off “ button located on the center of the  
instrument panel). If the Љsliding carЉ icon  
still illuminates steadily,  
have the system service by an authorized dealer immediately.  
Your vehicle may be equipped with the AdvanceTracsystem. The  
AdvanceTracsystem provides the following stability enhancement  
features for certain driving situations:  
Traction Control (TCS), which functions to help avoid drive-wheel  
spin and loss of traction.  
172  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC), which functions to help avoid skids  
or lateral slides  
The AdvanceTracsystem automatically enables each time the engine is  
started. All features of the AdvanceTracsystem (TCS and ESC) are  
active and monitor the vehicle from start-up. However, the system will  
only intervene if the driving situation requires it.  
The AdvanceTracsystem includes  
an AdvanceTrac௡ ЉOffЉ button on  
the center of the instrument panel,  
and a “sliding car” icon  
instrument cluster. The “sliding car”  
icon in the instrument cluster  
in the  
will illuminate temporarily during start-up as part of a normal system  
self-check, or during driving if a driving situation causes the  
AdvanceTracsystem to operate. If the “sliding car” icon  
illuminates  
steadily, verify that the AdvanceTracsystem is not manually disabled by  
pressing the AdvanceTrac௡ ЉOffЉ button located on the center stack of  
the instrument panel. If the “sliding car” icon  
remains steadily  
illuminated, have the system serviced by an authorized dealer  
immediately. If equipped with a message center, the vehicle will also  
indicate a failure with the AdvanceTracsystem.  
When AdvanceTracperforms a normal system self-check, some drivers  
may notice a slight movement of the brake, and/or a rumble, grunting, or  
grinding noise after startup and when driving off.  
When an event occurs that activates AdvanceTracyou may experience  
the following:  
A slight deceleration of the vehicle  
The “sliding car”  
indicator light will flash.  
A vibration in the pedal when your foot is on the brake pedal  
If the driving condition is severe and your foot is not on the brake, the  
brake pedal may move as the systems applies higher brake forces. You  
may also hear a whoosh of air from under the instrument panel during  
this severe condition.  
The brake pedal may feel stiffer than usual.  
173  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Traction Control (TCS)  
Traction Control is a driver aid feature that helps your vehicle maintain  
traction of the wheels, typically when driving on slippery and/or hilly  
road surfaces, by detecting and controlling wheel spin.  
Excessive wheel spin is controlled in two ways, which may work  
separately or in tandem, Engine Traction Control and Brake Traction  
Control. Engine Traction Control works to limit drive-wheel spin by  
momentarily reducing engine power. Brake Traction Control works to  
limit wheel spin by momentarily applying the brakes to the wheel that is  
slipping. Traction Control is most active at low speeds.  
During Traction Control events the “sliding car” icon  
instrument cluster will flash.  
in the  
If the Traction Control system is activated excessively in a short period  
of time, the braking portion of the system may become temporarily  
disabled to allow the brakes to cool down. In this situation, Traction  
Control will use only engine power reduction or transfer to help control  
the wheels from over-spinning. When the brakes have cooled down, the  
system will regain all features. Anti-lock braking, and ESC are not  
affected by this condition and will continue to function during the  
cool-down period.  
The Engine Traction Control and Brake Traction Control system may be  
deactivated in certain situations. See the Switching Off AdvanceTrac௡  
section below.  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) may enhance your vehicle’s directional  
stability during adverse maneuvers, for example when cornering severely  
or avoiding objects in the roadway. ESC operates by applying brakes to  
one or more of the wheels individually and, if necessary, reducing engine  
power if the system detects that the vehicle is about to skid or slide  
laterally.  
During Electronic Stability Control events the “sliding car” icon  
instrument cluster will flash.  
in the  
Certain adverse driving maneuvers may activate the Electronic Stability  
Control system, which include but are not limited to:  
Taking a turn too fast  
Maneuvering quickly to avoid an accident, pedestrian or obstacle  
Driving over a patch of ice or other slippery surfaces  
Changing lanes on a snow-rutted road  
174  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Entering a snow-free road from a snow-covered side street, or vice  
versa  
Entering a paved road from a gravel road, or vice versa  
Cornering while towing a heavily loaded trailer (refer to Trailer  
towing in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter).  
Switching Off AdvanceTrac௡  
If the vehicle is stuck in snow, mud or sand, and seems to lose engine  
power, switching off certain features of the AdvanceTracsystem may be  
beneficial because the wheels are allowed to spin. This will restore full  
engine power and will enhance momentum through the obstacle. To  
switch off the AdvanceTracsystem press the AdvanceTrac௡ ЉOffЉ  
button. Full features of the AdvanceTracsystem can be restored by  
pressing the AdvanceTrac௡ ЉOffЉ button again or by turning off and  
restarting the engine.  
If you switch off the AdvanceTracsystem, the Љsliding carЉ icon  
will  
illuminate steadily. Pressing the AdvanceTrac௡ ЉOffЉ button again will  
turn off the lighted button, Љsliding carЉ icon  
.
In R (Reverse), ABS and the Engine and Brake Traction Control features  
will continue to function; however, ESC is disabled.  
AdvanceTracFeatures  
“Sliding car”  
icon  
Traction  
Control  
Button functions  
ESC  
Illuminated  
during bulb  
check  
Default at start-up  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Disabled  
Enabled  
Button pressed  
momentarily  
Button pressed  
again after  
Illuminated solid  
Not illuminated  
deactivation  
175  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
STEERING  
To help prevent damage to the power steering system:  
Never hold the steering wheel at its furthest turning points (until it  
stops) for more than a few seconds when the engine is running.  
Do not operate the vehicle with a low power steering fluid level  
(below the MIN mark on the reservoir).  
Some noise is normal during operation. If the noise is excessive, check  
for a low power steering fluid level before seeking service by your  
authorized dealer.  
Heavy or uneven steering efforts may be caused by a low power  
steering fluid level. Check for a low power steering fluid level before  
seeking service by your authorized dealer.  
Do not fill the power steering fluid reservoir above the MAX mark on  
the reservoir.  
If the power steering system breaks down (or if the engine is turned  
off), you can steer the vehicle manually, but it takes more effort.  
If the steering wanders or pulls, check for:  
an improperly inflated tire  
uneven tire wear  
loose or worn suspension components  
loose or worn steering components  
improper steering alignment  
A high crown in the road or high crosswinds may also make the steering  
seem to wander/pull.  
176  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION OPERATION (IF EQUIPPED)  
Brake-shift interlock  
This vehicle is equipped with a brake-shift interlock feature that prevents  
the gearshift lever from being moved from P (Park) when the ignition is  
in the on position unless the brake pedal is depressed.  
If you cannot move the gearshift lever out of P (Park) with ignition in  
the on position and the brake pedal depressed:  
1. Apply the parking brake, turn ignition key to off, then remove the key.  
2. Insert a tool into the access hole  
and depress the override; while the  
override is depressed, move the  
shift lever to neutral.  
3. Start the vehicle.  
If it is necessary to use the above  
procedure to move the gearshift  
lever, it is possible that a fuse has  
blown or the vehicle’s brakelamps  
are not operating properly. Refer to  
Fuses and relays in the Roadside  
Emergencies chapter.  
WARNING: Do not drive your vehicle until you verify that the  
brakelamps are working.  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the off  
position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
WARNING: If the parking brake is fully released, but the brake  
warning lamp remains illuminated, the brakes may not be  
working properly. See your authorized dealer.  
177  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Understanding the gearshift positions of the 4–speed automatic  
transmission  
This vehicle is equipped with an adaptive Transmission Shift Strategy.  
Adaptive Shift Strategy offers the optimal transmission operation and  
shift quality. When the vehicle’s battery has been disconnected for any  
type of service or repair, the transmission will need to relearn the normal  
shift strategy parameters, much like having to reset your radio stations  
when your vehicle battery has been disconnected. The Adaptive  
Transmission Strategy allows the transmission to relearn these operating  
parameters. This learning process could take several transmission  
upshifts and downshifts; during this learning process, slightly firmer  
shifts may occur. After this learning process, normal shift feel and shift  
scheduling will resume.  
P (Park)  
This position locks the transmission and prevents the front wheels from  
turning.  
To put your vehicle in gear:  
Start the engine  
Depress the brake pedal  
Move the gearshift lever into the desired gear  
To put your vehicle in P (Park):  
Come to a complete stop  
Move the gearshift lever and securely latch it in P (Park)  
178  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the off  
position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
R (Reverse)  
With the gearshift lever in R (Reverse), the vehicle will move backward.  
Always come to a complete stop before shifting into and out of R  
(Reverse).  
N (Neutral)  
With the gearshift lever in N (Neutral), the vehicle can be started and is  
free to roll. Hold the brake pedal down while in this position.  
D (Drive) with Overdrive  
The normal driving position for the best fuel economy. Transmission  
operates in gears one through four.  
D (Drive) without Overdrive  
Overdrive can be deactivated by  
pressing the transmission control  
switch on the side of the gearshift  
lever.  
This position allows for all  
forward gears (1–3) except  
overdrive.  
Provides engine braking.  
Use when driving conditions  
cause excessive shifting from O/D  
to other gears. Examples: heavy  
city traffic where continuous  
shifting in and out of overdrive  
occurs, hilly terrain, heavy loads,  
trailer towing and when engine  
braking is required.  
O/D OFF lamp in the instrument  
O/D  
OFF  
cluster is illuminated.  
To return to O/D (overdrive  
mode), press the transmission  
control switch. The O/D OFF lamp in the instrument cluster will not  
be illuminated.  
179  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
O/D (overdrive) is automatically returned each time the key is turned  
off.  
L (Low)  
This position:  
Provides increased engine braking during downhill/mountain driving.  
Provides extended shift scheduling, allowing both upshifts and  
downshifts, at a higher overall RPM to provide optimum engine  
braking.  
Is not intended for use under extended or normal driving conditions  
and results in lower fuel economy.  
If your vehicle gets stuck in mud or snow  
If your vehicle gets stuck in mud or snow, it may be rocked out by  
shifting between forward and reverse gears, stopping between shifts in a  
steady pattern. Press lightly on the accelerator in each gear.  
If necessary, try turning the Traction Control™ system off. This will  
allow the wheels to spin, which may help to free your stuck vehicle. For  
more information, refer to Traction Control™ in this chapter.  
Do not rock the vehicle if the engine is not at normal operating  
temperature or damage to the transmission may occur.  
Do not rock the vehicle for more than a minute or damage to the  
transmission and tires may occur, or the engine may overheat.  
MANUAL TRANSMISSION OPERATION (IF EQUIPPED)  
1
2
3
4
5
R
Using the clutch  
Manual transmission vehicles have a starter interlock that prevents  
cranking the engine unless the clutch pedal is fully depressed.  
To start the vehicle:  
1. Make sure the parking brake is fully set.  
180  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
1. Press the clutch pedal to the  
floor, then put the gearshift lever in  
the neutral position.  
1
2
3
4
5
2. Start the engine.  
R
3. Press the brake pedal and move  
the gearshift lever to the desired  
gear; 1 (First) or R (Reverse).  
4. Release the parking brake, then slowly release the clutch pedal while  
slowly pressing on the accelerator.  
During each shift, the clutch pedal must be fully depressed to the floor.  
Make sure the floor mat is properly positioned so it doesn’t interfere with  
the full extension of the clutch pedal.  
Failure to fully depress the clutch pedal to the floor may cause  
increased shift efforts, prematurely wear transmission  
components or damage the transmission.  
Do not drive with your foot resting on the clutch pedal or use the  
clutch pedal to hold your vehicle at a standstill while waiting on a  
hill. These actions will severely reduce the life of the clutch and  
could nullify a clutch warranty claim.  
Recommended shift speeds  
Do not downshift into 1 (First) when your vehicle is moving  
faster than 15 mph (24 km/h). This will damage the clutch.  
Upshift according to the following chart:  
Recommended upshifts (for best fuel economy) when  
accelerating  
5-speed manual transmission  
Shift from:  
1 - 2  
2 - 3  
3 - 4  
4 - 5  
14 mph (23 km/h)  
24 mph (39 km/h)  
32 mph (51 km/h)  
44 mph (71 km/h)  
Reverse  
Make sure that your vehicle is at a complete stop before you shift  
into R (Reverse). Failure to do so may damage the transmission.  
Hold the clutch pedal down and move the gearshift lever into the neutral  
position. Wait at least three seconds before shifting into R (Reverse).  
181  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Note: The gearshift lever can only be moved into R (Reverse) by moving  
it from left of 3 (Third) and 4 (Fourth) before shifting into R (Reverse).  
This is a lockout feature that protects the transmission from accidentally  
being shifted into R (Reverse) from 5 (Fifth).  
If R (Reverse) is not fully engaged, press the clutch pedal down and  
return the gearshift to the neutral position. Release the clutch pedal for  
a moment, then press it down and shift to R (Reverse) again.  
Parking your vehicle  
1. Apply the brake and shift into the neutral position.  
2. Fully apply the parking brake, then shift into 1 (First).  
3. Turn the ignition off.  
WARNING: Do not park your vehicle in Neutral, it may move  
unexpectedly and injure someone. Use 1 (First) gear and set the  
parking brake fully.  
Removing the key  
Turn the ignition to position 1 (off) and remove the key.  
DRIVING THROUGH WATER  
If driving through deep or standing  
water is unavoidable, proceed very  
slowly especially when the depth is  
not known. Never drive through  
water that is higher than the bottom  
of the wheel rims (for cars) or the  
bottom of the hubs (for trucks).  
When driving through water, traction or brake capability may be limited.  
Also, water may enter your engine’s air intake and severely damage your  
engine or your vehicle may stall. Driving through deep water where  
the transmission vent tube is submerged may allow water into the  
transmission and cause internal transmission damage.  
Once through the water, always dry the brakes by moving your  
vehicle slowly while applying light pressure on the brake pedal.  
Wet brakes do not stop the vehicle as quickly as dry brakes.  
182  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE  
Getting roadside assistance  
To fully assist you should you have a vehicle concern, Ford Motor  
Company offers a complimentary roadside assistance program. This  
program is separate from the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. The service  
is available:  
24–hours, seven days a week  
for the coverage period listed on the Roadside Assistance Card  
included in your Owner Guide portfolio.  
Roadside assistance will cover:  
a flat tire change with a good spare (except vehicles that have been  
supplied with a tire inflation kit)  
battery jump start  
lock-out assistance (key replacement cost is the customer’s  
responsibility)  
fuel delivery – Independent Service Contractors, if not prohibited by  
state, local or municipal law shall deliver up to 2.0 gallons (7.5L) of  
gasoline or 5 gallons (18.9L) of diesel fuel to a disabled vehicle. Fuel  
delivery service is limited to two no-charge occurrences within a  
12-month period.  
winch out – available within 100 feet (30.5 meters) of a paved or  
county maintained road, no recoveries.  
towing – Ford/Mercury/Lincoln eligible vehicle towed to an authorized  
dealer within 35 miles (56.3 km) of the disablement location or to the  
nearest authorized dealer. If a member requests to be towed to an  
authorized dealer more than 35 miles (56.3 km) from the disablement  
location, the member shall be responsible for any mileage costs in  
excess of 35 miles (56.3 km).  
Trailers shall be covered up to $200 if the disabled eligible vehicle  
requires service at the nearest authorized dealer. If the trailer is disabled,  
but the towing vehicle is operational, the trailer does not qualify for any  
roadside services.  
183  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Canadian customers refer to your Customer Information Guide  
for information on:  
coverage period  
exact fuel amounts  
towing of your disabled vehicle  
emergency travel expense reimbursement  
travel planning benefits  
In Canada, for uninterrupted Roadside Assistance coverage, you may  
purchase extended coverage prior to your Basic Warranty’s Roadside  
Assistance expiring. For more information and enrollment, contact  
1–877–294–2582 or visit our website at www.ford.ca.  
Using roadside assistance  
Complete the roadside assistance identification card and place it in your  
wallet for quick reference. In the United States, this card is found in the  
Owner Guide portfolio in the glove compartment. In Canada, the card is  
found in the Customer Information Guide in the glove compartment.  
U.S. Ford, Mercury and Lincoln vehicle customers who require Roadside  
Assistance, call 1-800-241-3673.  
Canadian customers who require roadside assistance, call  
1-800-665-2006.  
If you need to arrange roadside assistance for yourself, Ford Motor  
Company will reimburse a reasonable amount for towing to the nearest  
dealership within 35 miles. To obtain reimbursement information, U.S.  
Ford, Mercury and Lincoln vehicle customers call 1-800-241-3673.  
Customers will be asked to submit their original receipts.  
Canadian customers who need to obtain reimbursement information, call  
1–800–665–2006.  
184  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
HAZARD FLASHER CONTROL  
The hazard flasher is located on the  
steering column, just behind the  
steering wheel. The hazard flashers  
will operate when the ignition is in  
any position or if the key is not in  
the ignition.  
Push in the flasher control and all  
front and rear direction signals will  
flash. Press the flasher control again  
to turn them off. Use it when your  
vehicle is disabled and is creating a  
safety hazard for other motorists.  
Note: With extended use, the flasher may run down your battery.  
FUEL PUMP SHUT-OFF SWITCH  
This device stops the electric fuel pump from sending fuel to the engine  
when your vehicle has had a substantial jolt.  
After an accident, if the engine cranks but does not start, this switch  
may have been activated.  
This switch is located in the front  
passenger’s footwell, behind the kick  
panel access cover.  
To reset the switch:  
1. Turn the ignition off.  
2. Check the fuel system for leaks.  
3. If no leaks are apparent, reset the  
switch by pushing in on the reset  
button.  
4. Turn the ignition to the on position.  
5. Wait a few seconds and return the key to off.  
6. Make another check for leaks.  
185  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
FUSES AND RELAYS  
Fuses  
If electrical components in the  
vehicle are not working, a fuse may  
have blown. Blown fuses are  
identified by a broken wire within  
the fuse. Check the appropriate  
fuses before replacing any electrical  
components.  
15  
Note: Always replace a fuse with one that has the specified amperage  
rating. Using a fuse with a higher amperage rating can cause severe wire  
damage and could start a fire.  
Standard fuse amperage rating and color  
COLOR  
Cartridge  
Fuse  
rating  
Mini  
fuses  
Standard  
fuses  
Maxi  
fuses  
Fuse link  
cartridge  
maxi  
fuses  
2A  
3A  
4A  
Grey  
Violet  
Pink  
Tan  
Grey  
Violet  
Pink  
Tan  
5A  
7.5A  
10A  
15A  
20A  
25A  
30A  
40A  
50A  
60A  
70A  
80A  
Brown  
Red  
Brown  
Red  
Yellow  
Green  
Orange  
Red  
Blue  
Tan  
Natural  
Blue  
Pink  
Green  
Red  
Yellow  
Blue  
Pink  
Green  
Red  
Yellow  
Brown  
Black  
Blue  
Yellow  
Natural  
Green  
Blue  
Yellow  
Natural  
Green  
Black  
186  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Passenger compartment fuse panel  
The fuse panel is located below and to the left of the steering wheel by  
the brake pedal. Remove the fuse panel cover to gain access to the fuses.  
To remove a fuse use the fuse puller tool provided on the fuse panel  
cover.  
The fuses are coded as follows.  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
30A  
Protected circuits  
Not used (spare)  
Brake Switch CHMSL  
Satellite radio  
Not used (spare)  
Shift Interlock  
Right Front Turn lamp/Left Front  
Turn lamp, Rear stop/turn lamps  
1
2
3
4
5
6
15A  
15A  
30A  
10A  
20A  
187  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
10A  
10A  
15A  
15A  
10A  
7.5A  
5A  
Protected circuits  
7
8
9
Left Low beam Headlamp  
Right Low beam Headlamp  
Interior Lamps  
Instrument Panel Backlighting  
Not used (spare)  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
Power Mirrors  
SYNC  
10A  
10A  
15A  
20A  
20A  
25A  
15A  
15A  
15A  
15A  
20A  
10A  
10A  
20A  
5A  
Not used (spare)  
Recirculated Air, Air Conditioning  
Not used (spare)  
Power Locks, Trunk Release  
Heated Seats  
Not used (spare)  
Data Link Connector  
Fog lamps, Fog lamp Indicator  
Parking Lamps  
High Beam Lamps  
Horn  
Demand Lamps, Trunk Lamps  
Instrument Cluster  
Ignition Switch  
Radio (Start)  
Instrument Cluster (Run/Start)  
Not used (spare)  
5A  
5A  
10A  
10A  
10A  
5A  
10A  
5A  
ABS  
Restraints Control Module  
Not used (spare)  
Not used (spare)  
Not used (spare)  
PATS Module  
10A  
Climate Control (Run/Start)  
188  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
20A  
Protected circuits  
38  
39  
40  
41  
Subwoofer  
Radio/CID/EFP  
Not used (spare)  
Door Lock/sunroof switch  
illumination, Electrochromic  
mirror, Ambient lighting  
Not used (spare)  
Not used (spare)  
Not used (spare)  
20A  
20A  
15A  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
10A  
10A  
10A  
5A  
7.5A  
Front Wipers (logic)  
Front Passenger Sensing System  
Sunroof, Power Windows  
30A (circuit  
breaker)  
48  
Delayed accessory relay  
Power distribution box  
The power distribution box is located in the engine compartment. The  
power distribution box contains high-current fuses that protect your  
vehicle’s main electrical systems from overloads.  
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery before servicing high  
current fuses.  
WARNING: To reduce risk of electrical shock, always replace  
the cover to the Power Distribution Box before reconnecting the  
battery or refilling fluid reservoirs.  
If the battery has been disconnected and reconnected, refer to the  
Battery section of the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
189  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
To remove a fuse, use the fuse puller tool provided on the inside of the  
passenger compartment fuse panel cover.  
The high-current fuses are coded as follows:  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
15A  
Protected circuits  
1
2
3
4
5
Heated mirror  
30A  
20A  
20A  
10A  
Rear defrost  
Power point  
Fuel pump  
Powertrain control module (PCM)  
KAPWR / Canister Vent  
Alt sense  
6
7
8
15A  
10A  
Reverse lamps  
Not used  
9
40A  
30A  
30A  
40A  
10A  
ABS motor  
Wipers  
Starter  
Blower  
10  
11  
12  
13  
A/C clutch  
190  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
14  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
10A  
Protected circuits  
PCM relay coil  
Front power point  
Cooling fan—low  
Cooling fan—high  
ABS solenoid  
Not used  
15  
16  
17  
18  
20A  
20A  
30A  
20A  
19  
20  
A/C clutch relay  
Rear defrost relay  
Not used  
Blower relay  
PCM relay  
21A  
21B  
21C  
21D  
22  
10A  
Fuel injector  
Not used  
23  
24  
Not used  
25  
Not used  
26  
27  
15A  
PCM MIL  
Not used  
28  
29  
15A  
15A  
PCM  
Ignition  
30A  
30B  
30C  
30D  
31A  
31B  
31C  
31D  
31E  
31F  
32  
Cooling fan low speed relay  
Starter relay  
Not used  
Cooling fan high speed relay  
Reverse lamp relay  
Fuel pump relay  
Wiper power relay  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
A/C clutch diode  
EEC diode  
33  
34  
One Touch Integrated Start  
(OTIS) diode  
Run/Start  
35  
10A  
191  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
CHANGING A FLAT TIRE  
If you get a flat tire while driving:  
do not brake heavily.  
gradually decrease the vehicle’s speed.  
hold the steering wheel firmly.  
slowly move to a safe place on the side of the road.  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a conventional spare tire that is  
different in one or more of the following: type, brand, size, speed rating  
and tread design. If this is the case, this dissimilar spare tire is still rated  
for your vehicle loads (GAWR and GVWR). This temporary spare tire is  
not equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) sensor.  
Note: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) indicator light will  
illuminate when the spare is in use. To restore the full functionality of  
the TPMS system, all road wheels equipped with the tire pressure  
monitoring sensors must be mounted on the vehicle.  
Have a flat tire serviced by an authorized dealer in order to prevent  
damage to the TPMS sensor, refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring System  
(TPMS) in the Tires, Wheels, and Loading chapter. Replace the spare  
tire with a road tire as soon as possible. During repairing or replacing of  
the flat tire, have the authorized dealer inspect the TPMS sensor for  
damage.  
WARNING: The use of tire sealants may damage your Tire  
Pressure Monitoring System and should not be used.  
WARNING: Refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)  
in the Tire, Wheels and Loading chapter for important  
information. If the tire pressure monitor sensor becomes damaged, it  
will no longer function.  
Dissimilar spare tire/wheel information  
WARNING: Failure to follow these guidelines could result in an  
increased risk of loss of vehicle control, injury or death.  
If you have a dissimilar spare tire/wheel, then it is intended for  
temporary use only. This means that if you need to use it, you should  
replace it as soon as possible with a road tire/wheel that is the same size  
192  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
and type as the road tires and wheels that were originally provided by  
Ford. If the dissimilar spare tire or wheel is damaged, it should be  
replaced rather than repaired.  
A dissimilar spare tire/wheel is defined as a spare tire and/or wheel that  
is different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires and wheels  
and can be one of three types:  
1. T-type mini-spare: This spare tire begins with the letter “T” for tire  
size and may have “Temporary Use Only” molded in the sidewall  
2. Full-size dissimilar spare with label on wheel: This spare tire has  
a label on the wheel that states: “THIS TIRE AND WHEEL FOR  
TEMPORARY USE ONLY”  
When driving with one of the dissimilar spare tires listed above, do not:  
Exceed 50 mph (80 km/h)  
Load the vehicle beyond maximum vehicle load rating listed on the  
Safety Compliance Label  
Tow a trailer  
Use snow chains on the end of the vehicle with the dissimilar spare  
tire  
Use more than one dissimilar spare tire at a time  
Use commercial car washing equipment  
Try to repair the dissimilar spare tire  
Use of one of the dissimilar spare tires listed above at any one wheel  
location can lead to impairment of the following:  
Handling, stability and braking performance  
Comfort and noise  
Ground clearance and parking at curbs  
Winter weather driving capability  
Wet weather driving capability  
3. Full-size dissimilar spare without label on wheel  
When driving with the full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel, do not:  
Exceed 70 mph (113 km/h)  
Use more than one dissimilar spare tire/wheel at a time  
Use commercial car washing equipment  
Use snow chains on the end of the vehicle with the dissimilar spare  
tire/wheel  
193  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
The usage of a full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel can lead to  
impairment of the following:  
Handling, stability and braking performance  
Comfort and noise  
Ground clearance and parking at curbs  
Winter weather driving capability  
Wet weather driving capability  
All-Wheel driving capability (if applicable)  
Load leveling adjustment (if applicable)  
When driving with the full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel additional  
caution should be given to:  
Towing a trailer  
Driving vehicles equipped with a camper body  
Driving vehicles with a load on the cargo rack  
Drive cautiously when using a full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel and  
seek service as soon as possible.  
Stopping and securing the vehicle  
1. Park on a level surface, set the  
parking brake and activate the  
hazard flashers.  
2. Place the gearshift lever in P (Park) (automatic transmission) or R  
(Reverse) (manual transmission) and turn the engine off.  
Tire change procedure  
WARNING: When one of the front wheels is off the ground, the  
transmission alone will not prevent the vehicle from moving or  
slipping off the jack, even if the vehicle is in P (Park) (automatic  
transmission) or R (Reverse) (manual transmission).  
194  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
WARNING: To help prevent the vehicle from moving when you  
change a tire, be sure the parking brake is set, then block (in  
both directions) the wheel that is diagonally opposite (other side and  
end of the vehicle) to the tire being changed.  
WARNING: If the vehicle slips off the jack, you or someone else  
could be seriously injured.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the  
vehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far enough off the road to  
avoid the danger of being hit when operating the jack or changing the  
wheel.  
1. Remove the spare tire and jack by  
turning their tie-down bolts  
counterclockwise. The lug wrench is  
located in a bag next to, or on top  
of, the spare tire.  
2. Block the diagonally opposite  
wheel.  
3. If equipped with a 6-spoke wheel  
cover that’s bolted on, remove the  
four plastic nuts by turning  
counterclockwise 1/4 turn for access  
to the lug nuts.  
Note: To avoid damage to the wheel  
cover, the 6-spoke wheel cover  
cannot be removed until the tire is  
off the vehicle.  
195  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
4. Loosen each wheel lug nut  
one-half turn counterclockwise but  
do not remove them until the wheel  
is raised off the ground.  
5. The vehicle jacking points are  
depicted on the yellow warning label  
on the jack shown here (2-door  
model shown, 4-door model similar).  
Depending on which tire is to be  
changed, put the jack approximately  
7 inches (18 cm) from the front  
wheel opening (1) or approximately  
17 inches (43 cm) from the rear  
wheel opening (2).  
Jack at the specified locations  
to avoid damage to the vehicle.  
WARNING: To lessen the  
risk of personal injury, do  
not put any part of your body  
under the vehicle while changing a  
tire. Do not start the engine when  
your vehicle is on the jack. The  
jack is only meant for changing  
the tire.  
6. Remove the lug nuts with the lug wrench.  
7. Replace the flat tire with the spare tire, making sure the valve stem is  
facing outward. Reinstall the lug nuts until the wheel is snug against the  
hub. Do not fully tighten the lug nuts until the wheel has been lowered.  
8. Lower the wheel by turning the jack handle counterclockwise.  
196  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
9. Remove the jack and fully tighten  
the lug nuts in the order shown.  
Refer to Wheel lug nut torque  
specifications later in this chapter  
for the proper lug nut torque  
specification.  
1
3
4
10. Put the flat tire, jack and lug  
wrench away. Make sure the jack is  
fastened so it does not rattle when  
you drive. Unblock the wheels.  
2
WHEEL LUG NUT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS  
Retighten the lug nuts to the specified torque at 500 miles (800 km)  
after any wheel disturbance (tire rotation, changing a flat tire, wheel  
removal, etc.).  
Bolt size  
Wheel lug nut torque*  
lb. ft.  
100  
Nm  
M12 x 1.5  
135  
* Torque specifications are for nut and bolt threads free of dirt and  
rust. Use only Ford recommended replacement fasteners.  
WARNING: When a wheel is installed, always remove any  
corrosion, dirt or foreign materials present on the mounting  
surfaces of the wheel or the surface of the wheel hub, brake drum or  
brake disc that contacts the wheel. Ensure that any fasteners that  
attach the rotor to the hub are secured so they do not interfere with  
the mounting surfaces of the wheel. Installing wheels without correct  
metal-to-metal contact at the wheel mounting surfaces can cause the  
wheel nuts to loosen and the wheel to come off while the vehicle is in  
motion, resulting in loss of control.  
197  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Note: Inspect the wheel pilot hole  
prior to installation. If there is  
visible corrosion in wheel pilot hole,  
remove loose particles by wiping  
with clean rag and apply grease.  
Apply grease only to the wheel pilot  
hole surface by smearing a “dime”  
(1 square cm) sized glob of grease  
around the wheel pilot surface (1)  
with end of finger. DO NOT apply  
grease to lugnut/stud holes or  
wheel-to-brake surfaces.  
JUMP STARTING  
WARNING: The gases around the battery can explode if  
exposed to flames, sparks, or lit cigarettes. An explosion could  
result in injury or vehicle damage.  
WARNING: Batteries contain sulfuric acid which can burn skin,  
eyes and clothing, if contacted.  
Do not attempt to push-start your automatic transmission  
vehicle. Automatic transmissions do not have push-start  
capability. Attempting to push-start a vehicle with an automatic  
transmission may cause transmission damage.  
Preparing your vehicle  
When the battery is disconnected or a new battery is installed, the  
automatic transmission must relearn its shift strategy. As a result, the  
transmission may have firm and/or soft shifts. This operation is  
considered normal and will not affect function or durability of the  
transmission. Over time, the adaptive learning process will fully update  
transmission operation.  
1. Use only a 12–volt supply to start your vehicle.  
2. Do not disconnect the battery of the disabled vehicle as this could  
damage the vehicle’s electrical system.  
3. Park the booster vehicle close to the hood of the disabled vehicle  
making sure the two vehicles do not touch. Set the parking brake on  
both vehicles and stay clear of the engine cooling fan and other moving  
parts.  
198  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
4. Check all battery terminals and remove any excessive corrosion before  
you attach the battery cables. Ensure that vent caps are tight and level.  
5. Turn the heater fan on in both vehicles to protect from any electrical  
surges. Turn all other accessories off.  
Connecting the jumper cables  
1. Connect the positive (+) jumper cable to the positive (+) terminal of  
the discharged battery.  
Note: In the illustrations, lightning bolts are used to designate the  
assisting (boosting) battery.  
2. Connect the other end of the positive (+) cable to the positive (+)  
terminal of the assisting battery.  
199  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
3. Connect the negative (-) cable to the negative (-) terminal of the  
assisting battery.  
4. Make the final connection of the negative (-) cable to an exposed  
metal part of the stalled vehicle’s engine, away from the battery and the  
carburetor/fuel injection system. Do not use fuel lines, engine rocker  
covers or the intake manifold as grounding points.  
WARNING: Do not connect the end of the second cable to the  
negative (-) terminal of the battery to be jumped. A spark may  
cause an explosion of the gases that surround the battery.  
5. Ensure that the cables are clear of fan blades, belts, moving parts of  
both engines, or any fuel delivery system parts.  
200  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Jump starting  
1. Start the engine of the booster vehicle and run the engine at  
moderately increased speed.  
2. Start the engine of the disabled vehicle.  
3. Once the disabled vehicle has been started, run both engines for an  
additional three minutes before disconnecting the jumper cables.  
Removing the jumper cables  
Remove the jumper cables in the reverse order that they were  
connected.  
1. Remove the jumper cable from the ground metal surface.  
Note: In the illustrations, lightning bolts are used to designate the  
assisting (boosting) battery.  
2. Remove the jumper cable on the negative (-) connection of the  
booster vehicle’s battery.  
201  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
3. Remove the jumper cable from the positive (+) terminal of the booster  
vehicle’s battery.  
4. Remove the jumper cable from the positive (+) terminal of the  
disabled vehicle’s battery.  
After the disabled vehicle has been started and the jumper cables  
removed, allow it to idle for several minutes so the engine computer can  
relearn its idle conditions.  
202  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
WRECKER TOWING  
If you need to have your vehicle towed, contact a professional towing  
service or, if you are a member of a roadside assistance program, your  
roadside assistance service provider.  
It is recommended that your vehicle be towed with a wheel lift or flatbed  
equipment. Do not tow with a slingbelt. Ford Motor Company has not  
approved a slingbelt towing procedure.  
If your vehicle is to be towed from the rear using wheel lift equipment,  
the front wheels (drive wheels) must be placed on a dolly to prevent  
damage to the transmission.  
If the vehicle is towed by other means or incorrectly, vehicle  
damage may occur.  
Ford Motor Company produces a towing manual for all authorized tow  
truck operators. Have your tow truck operator refer to this manual for  
proper hook-up and towing procedures for your vehicle.  
203  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Emergency towing  
In case of a roadside emergency with a disabled vehicle (without access  
to wheel dollies, car hauling trailer, or flatbed transport vehicle) your  
vehicle (regardless of transmission powertrain configuration) can be flat  
towed (all wheels on the ground) under the following conditions:  
Vehicle is facing forward so that it is being towed in a forward  
direction.  
Place the transmission in N (Neutral). Refer to Brake shift interlock  
in the Driving chapter for specific instructions if you cannot move the  
gear shift lever into N (Neutral).  
Maximum speed is not to exceed 35 mph (56 km/h).  
Maximum distance is 50 miles (80 km).  
204  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
GETTING THE SERVICES YOU NEED  
Warranty repairs to your vehicle must be performed by an authorized  
Ford, Lincoln, or Mercury dealer. While any authorized dealer handling  
your vehicle line will provide warranty service, we recommend you  
return to your selling authorized dealer who wants to ensure your  
continued satisfaction.  
Please note that certain warranty repairs require special training and/or  
equipment, so not all authorized dealers are authorized to perform all  
warranty repairs. This means that, depending on the warranty repair  
needed, you may have to take your vehicle to another authorized dealer.  
A reasonable time must be allowed to perform a repair after taking your  
vehicle to the authorized dealer. Repairs will be made using Ford or  
Motorcraft parts, or remanufactured or other parts that are authorized by  
Ford.  
Away from home  
If you are away from home when your vehicle needs service, contact the  
Ford Customer Relationship Center or use the online resources listed  
below to find the nearest authorized dealer.  
In the United States:  
Mailing Address  
Ford Motor Company  
Customer Relationship Center  
P.O. Box 6248  
Dearborn, MI 48121  
Telephone  
1-800-392-3673 (FORD)  
(TDD for the hearing impaired: 1-800-232-5952)  
Online  
Additional information and resources are available online at  
www.genuineservice.com.  
U.S. dealer locator by Dealer Name, City/State, or Zip Code  
Owner Guides  
Maintenance Schedules  
Recalls  
Ford Extended Service Plans  
Ford Genuine Accessories  
Service specials and promotions.  
205  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
In Canada:  
Mailing Address (Ford vehicles)  
Customer Relationship Centre  
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited  
P.O. Box 2000  
Oakville, Ontario L6J 5E4  
Telephone  
1-800-565-3673 (FORD)  
Online  
www.ford.ca  
Mailing Address (Lincoln vehicles)  
Lincoln Centre  
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited  
P.O. Box 2000  
Oakville, Ontario L6J 5E4  
Telephone  
1-800-387-9333  
Online  
www.lincolncanada.com  
Additional Assistance  
If you have questions or concerns, or are unsatisfied with the service you  
are receiving, follow these steps:  
1. Contact your Sales Representative or Service Advisor at your  
selling/servicing authorized dealer.  
2. If your inquiry or concern remains unresolved, contact the Sales  
Manager, Service Manager or Customer Relations Manager.  
3. If you require assistance or clarification on Ford Motor Company  
policies, please contact the Ford Customer Relationship Center  
In order to help you serve you better, please have the following  
information available when contacting a Customer Relationship Center:  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
Your telephone number (home and business)  
The name of the authorized dealer and city where located  
The vehicle’s current odometer reading  
In some states, you must directly notify Ford in writing before pursuing  
remedies under your state’s warranty laws. Ford is also allowed a final  
repair attempt in some states.  
206  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
In the United States, a warranty dispute must be submitted to the BBB  
AUTO LINE before taking action under the Magnuson-Moss Warranty  
Act, or to the extent allowed by state law, before pursuing replacement  
or repurchase remedies provided by certain state laws. This dispute  
handling procedure is not required prior to enforcing state created rights  
or other rights which are independent of the Magnuson-Moss Warranty  
Act or state replacement or repurchase laws.  
IN CALIFORNIA (U.S. ONLY)  
California Civil Code Section 1793.2(d) requires that, if a manufacturer  
or its representative is unable to repair a motor vehicle to conform to the  
vehicle’s applicable express warranty after a reasonable number of  
attempts, the manufacturer shall be required to either replace the  
vehicle with one substantially identical or repurchase the vehicle and  
reimburse the buyer in an amount equal to the actual price paid or  
payable by the consumer (less a reasonable allowance for consumer  
use). The consumer has the right to choose whether to receive a refund  
or replacement vehicle.  
California Civil Code Section 1793.22(b) presumes that the manufacturer  
has had a reasonable number of attempts to conform the vehicle to its  
applicable express warranties if, within the first 18 months of ownership  
of a new vehicle or the first 18,000 miles (29,000 km), whichever occurs  
first:  
1. Two or more repair attempts are made on the same non-conformity  
likely to cause death or serious bodily injury OR  
2. Four or more repair attempts are made on the same nonconformity (a  
defect or condition that substantially impairs the use, value or safety of  
the vehicle) OR  
3. The vehicle is out of service for repair of nonconformities for a total of  
more than 30 calendar days (not necessarily all at one time)  
In the case of 1 or 2 above, the consumer must also notify the  
manufacturer of the need for the repair of the nonconformity at the  
following address:  
Ford Motor Company  
16800 Executive Plaza Drive  
Mail Drop 3NE-B  
Dearborn, MI 48126  
207  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
THE BETTER BUSINESS BUREAU (BBB) AUTO LINE PROGRAM  
(U.S. ONLY)  
Your satisfaction is important to Ford Motor Company and to your dealer.  
If a warranty concern has not been resolved using the three-step  
procedure outlined on the first page of the Customer Assistance section,  
you may be eligible to participate in the BBB AUTO LINE program.  
The BBB AUTO LINE program consists of two parts – mediation and  
arbitration. During mediation, a representative of the BBB will contact  
both you and Ford Motor Company to explore options for settlement of  
the claim. If an agreement is not reached during mediation and your  
claim is eligible, you may participate in the arbitration process. An  
arbitration hearing will be scheduled so that you can present your case  
in an informal setting before an impartial person. The arbitrator will  
consider the testimony provided and make a decision after the hearing.  
You are not bound by the decision, but should you choose to accept the  
BBB AUTO LINE decision, Ford must abide by the accepted decision as  
well. Disputes submitted to the BBB AUTO LINE program are usually  
decided within forty days after you file your claim with the BBB.  
BBB AUTO LINE Application: Using the information provided below,  
please call or write to request a program application. You will be asked  
for your name and address, general information about your new vehicle,  
information about your warranty concerns, and any steps you have  
already taken to try to resolve them. A Customer Claim Form will be  
mailed that will need to be completed, signed and returned to the BBB  
along with proof of ownership. Upon receipt, the BBB will review the  
claim for eligibility under the Program Summary Guidelines.  
You can get more information by calling BBB AUTO LINE at  
1-800-955-5100, or writing to:  
BBB AUTO LINE  
4200 Wilson Boulevard, Suite 800  
Arlington, Virginia 22203–1833  
BBB AUTO LINE applications can also be requested by calling the Ford  
Motor Company Customer Relationship Center at 1-800-392-3673.  
Note: Ford Motor Company reserves the right to change eligibility  
limitations, modify procedures, or to discontinue this process at any time  
without notice and without obligation.  
208  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
UTILIZING THE MEDIATION/ARBITRATION PROGRAM  
(CANADA ONLY)  
For vehicles delivered to authorized Canadian dealers. In those cases  
where you continue to feel that the efforts by Ford of Canada and the  
authorized dealer to resolve a factory-related vehicle service concern  
have been unsatisfactory, Ford of Canada participates in an impartial  
third party mediation/arbitration program administered by the Canadian  
Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP).  
The CAMVAP program is a straight-forward and relatively speedy  
alternative to resolve a disagreement when all other efforts to produce a  
settlement have failed. This procedure is without cost to you and is  
designed to eliminate the need for lengthy and expensive legal  
proceedings.  
In the CAMVAP program, impartial third-party arbitrators conduct  
hearings at mutually convenient times and places in an informal  
environment. These impartial arbitrators review the positions of the  
parties, make decisions and, when appropriate, render awards to resolve  
disputes. CAMVAP decisions are fast, fair, and final as the arbitrator’s  
award is binding both to you and Ford of Canada.  
CAMVAP services are available in all territories and provinces. For more  
information, without charge or obligation, call your CAMVAP Provincial  
Administrator directly at 1-800-207-0685.  
FORD EXTENDED SERVICE PLAN  
You can get more protection for your new car or light truck by  
purchasing Ford Extended Service Plan (Ford ESP) coverage. It provides  
the following:  
Benefits during the warranty period depending on the plan you  
purchase (such as: reimbursement for rentals; coverage for certain  
maintenance and wear items).  
Protection against covered repair costs after your Bumper-to-Bumper  
Warranty expires.  
You may purchase Ford ESP from any participating authorized dealer.  
There are several plans available in various time, distance and deductible  
combinations which can be tailored to fit your own driving needs. Ford  
ESP also offers reimbursement benefits for towing and rental coverage.  
When you buy Ford ESP, you receive Peace-of-Mind protection  
throughout the United States and Canada, provided by a network of  
more than 4,600 participating authorized dealers.  
209  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
If you did not take advantage of the Ford Extended Service Plan at the  
time of purchasing your vehicle, you may still be eligible. Since this  
information is subject to change, please ask your authorized dealer for  
complete details about Ford Extended Service Plan coverage options, or  
visit the Ford ESP website at www.ford-esp.com.  
GETTING ASSISTANCE OUTSIDE THE U.S. AND CANADA  
Before exporting your vehicle to a foreign country, contact the  
appropriate foreign embassy or consulate. These officials can inform you  
of local vehicle registration regulations and where to find unleaded fuel.  
If you cannot find unleaded fuel or can only get fuel with an anti-knock  
index lower than is recommended for your vehicle, contact a regional  
office or owner relations/customer relationship office.  
The use of leaded fuel in your vehicle without proper conversion may  
damage the effectiveness of your emission control system and may cause  
engine knocking or serious engine damage. Ford Motor Company/Ford of  
Canada is not responsible for any damage caused by use of improper  
fuel. Using leaded fuel may also result in difficulty importing your vehicle  
back into the U.S.  
If your vehicle must be serviced while you are traveling or living in  
Central America, the Caribbean, or the Middle East, contact the nearest  
authorized dealer. If the authorized dealer cannot help you, contact:  
FORD MOTOR COMPANY  
FORD EXPORT OPERATIONS  
1555 Fairlane Drive  
Fairlane Business Park #3  
Allen Park, Michigan 48101  
U.S.A.  
Telephone: (313) 594-4857  
FAX: (313) 390-0804  
If you are in another foreign country, contact the nearest authorized  
dealer. If the authorized dealer employees cannot help you, they can  
direct you to the nearest Ford affiliate office.  
If you buy your vehicle in North America and then relocate outside of  
the U.S. or Canada, register your vehicle identification number (VIN) and  
new address with Ford Motor Company Export Operations.  
Customers in the U.S. should call 1-800-392-3673.  
210  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
ORDERING ADDITIONAL OWNER’S LITERATURE  
To order the publications in this portfolio, contact Helm, Incorporated at:  
HELM, INCORPORATED  
P.O. Box 07150  
Detroit, Michigan 48207  
Or to order a free publication catalog, call toll free: 1-800-782-4356  
Monday-Friday 8:00 a.m. - 6:00 p.m. EST  
Helm, Incorporated can also be reached by their website:  
www.helminc.com.  
(Items in this catalog may be purchased by credit card, check or  
money order.)  
Obtaining a French owner’s guide  
French Owner’s Guides can be obtained from your authorized dealer or  
by writing to:  
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited  
Service Publications CHQ202  
The Canadian Road  
P.O. Box 2000  
Oakville, ON, Canada  
L6J 5E4  
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (U.S. ONLY)  
If you believe that your vehicle has  
a defect which could cause a crash  
or could cause injury or death, you  
should immediately inform the  
National Highway Traffic Safety  
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Ford Motor Company.  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and  
if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a  
recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved  
in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Ford Motor  
Company.  
211  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at  
1–888–327–4236 (TTY: 1–800–424–9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov;  
or write to:  
Administrator  
1200 New Jersey Avenue, Southeast  
Washington, D.C. 20590  
You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from  
http://www.safercar.gov.  
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (CANADA ONLY)  
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or  
could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform Transport  
Canada, using their toll-free number: 1–800–333–0510.  
212  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
WASHING THE EXTERIOR  
Wash your vehicle regularly with cool or lukewarm water and a neutral  
pH shampoo, such as Motorcraft Detail Wash (ZC-3-A), which is available  
from your authorized dealer.  
Never use strong household detergents or soap, such as dish washing  
or laundry liquid. These products can discolor and spot painted  
surfaces.  
Never wash a vehicle that is “hot to the touch” or during exposure to  
strong, direct sunlight.  
Always use a clean sponge or car wash mitt with plenty of water for  
best results.  
Dry the vehicle with a chamois or soft terry cloth towel in order to  
eliminate water spotting.  
It is especially important to wash the vehicle regularly during the  
winter months, as dirt and road salt are difficult to remove and cause  
damage to the vehicle.  
Immediately remove items such as gasoline, diesel fuel, bird droppings  
and insect deposits because they can cause damage to the vehicle’s  
paintwork and trim over time. Use Motorcraft Bug and Tar Remover  
(ZC-42) which is available from your authorized dealer.  
Remove any exterior accessories, such as antennas, before entering a  
car wash.  
Suntan lotions and insect repellents can damage any painted  
surface; if these substances come in contact with your vehicle,  
wash off as soon as possible.  
Exterior chrome  
Wash the vehicle first, using cool or lukewarm water and a neutral pH  
shampoo, such as Motorcraft Detail Wash (ZC-3-A).  
Use Motorcraft Custom Bright Metal Cleaner (ZC-15), available from  
your authorized dealer. Apply the product as you would a wax to  
clean bumpers and other chrome parts; allow the cleaner to dry for a  
few minutes, then wipe off the haze with a clean, dry rag.  
Never use abrasive materials such as steel wool or plastic pads  
as they can scratch the chrome surface.  
After polishing chrome bumpers, apply a coating of Motorcraft  
Premium Liquid Wax (ZC-53-A), available from your authorized dealer,  
or an equivalent quality product to help protect from environmental  
effects.  
213  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
WAXING  
Wash the vehicle first.  
Do not use waxes that contain abrasives; use Motorcraft Premium  
Liquid Wax (ZC-53-A), which is available from your authorized dealer,  
or an equivalent quality product.  
Do not allow paint sealant to come in contact with any non-body  
(low-gloss black) colored trim, such as grained door handles, roof  
racks, bumpers, side moldings, mirror housings or the windshield cowl  
area. The paint sealant will “gray” or stain the parts over time.  
PAINT CHIPS  
Your authorized dealer has touch-up paint to match your vehicle’s color.  
Take your color code (printed on a sticker in the driver’s door jamb) to  
your authorized dealer to ensure you get the correct color.  
Remove particles such as bird droppings, tree sap, insect deposits, tar  
spots, road salt and industrial fallout before repairing paint chips.  
Always read the instructions before using the products.  
ALUMINUM WHEELS AND WHEEL COVERS  
Aluminum wheels and wheel covers are coated with a clearcoat paint  
finish. In order to maintain their shine:  
Clean weekly with Motorcraft Wheel and Tire Cleaner (ZC-37-A),  
which is available from your authorized dealer. Heavy dirt and brake  
dust accumulation may require agitation with a sponge. Rinse  
thoroughly with a strong stream of water.  
Never apply any cleaning chemical to hot or warm wheel rims or  
covers.  
Some automatic car washes may cause damage to the finish on your  
wheel rims or covers. Chemical-strength cleaners, or cleaning  
chemicals, in combination with brush agitation to remove brake dust  
and dirt, could wear away the clearcoat finish over time.  
Do not use hydrofluoric acid-based or high caustic-based wheel  
cleaners, steel wool, fuels or strong household detergent.  
To remove tar and grease, use Motorcraft Bug and Tar Remover  
(ZC-42), available from your authorized dealer.  
214  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
ENGINE  
Engines are more efficient when they are clean because grease and dirt  
buildup keep the engine warmer than normal.  
When washing:  
Take care when using a power washer to clean the engine. The  
high-pressure fluid could penetrate the sealed parts and cause  
damage.  
Do not spray a hot engine with cold water to avoid cracking the  
engine block or other engine components.  
Spray Motorcraft Engine Shampoo and Degreaser (ZC-20) on all parts  
that require cleaning and pressure rinse clean. In Canada use  
Motorcraft Engine Shampoo (CXC-66-A).  
Never wash or rinse the engine while it is running; water in the  
running engine may cause internal damage.  
Cover the highlighted areas to prevent water damage when cleaning  
the engine.  
PLASTIC (NON-PAINTED) EXTERIOR PARTS  
Use only approved products to clean plastic parts. These products are  
available from your authorized dealer.  
For routine cleaning, use Motorcraft Detail Wash (ZC-3-A).  
If tar or grease spots are present, use Motorcraft Bug and Tar  
Remover (ZC-42).  
For plastic headlamp lenses, use Motorcraft Ultra Clear Spray Glass  
Cleaner (ZC-23).  
215  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
WINDOWS AND WIPER BLADES  
The windshield, rear and side windows and the wiper blades should be  
cleaned regularly. If the wipers do not wipe properly, substances on the  
vehicle’s glass or the wiper blades may be the cause. These may include  
hot wax treatments used by commercial car washes, water repellent  
coatings, tree sap, or other organic contamination; these contaminants  
may cause squeaking or chatter noise from the blades, and streaking and  
smearing of the windshield. To clean these items, follow these tips:  
The windshield, rear windows and side windows may be cleaned with  
a non-abrasive cleaner such as Motorcraft Ultra-Clear Spray Glass  
Cleaner (ZC-23), available from your authorized dealer.  
The wiper blades can be cleaned with isopropyl (rubbing) alcohol or  
Motorcraft Premium Windshield Washer Concentrate (ZC-32-A),  
available from your authorized dealer. This washer fluid contains  
special solution in addition to alcohol which helps to remove the hot  
wax deposited on the wiper blade and windshield from automated car  
wash facilities. Be sure to replace wiper blades when they appear  
worn or do not function properly.  
Do not use abrasives, as they may cause scratches.  
Do not use fuel, kerosene, or paint thinner to clean any parts.  
If you cannot remove those streaks after cleaning with the glass cleaner  
or if the wipers chatter and move in a jerky motion, clean the outer  
surface of the windshield and the wiper blades using a sponge or soft  
cloth with a neutral detergent or mild-abrasive cleaning solution. After  
cleaning, rinse the windshield and wiper blades with clean water. The  
windshield is clean if beads do not form when you rinse the windshield  
with water.  
Do not use sharp objects, such as a razor blade, to clean the  
inside of the rear window or to remove decals, as it may cause  
damage to the rear window defroster’s heated grid lines.  
INSTRUMENT PANEL/INTERIOR TRIM AND CLUSTER LENS  
Clean the instrument panel, interior trim areas and cluster lens with a  
clean and damp white cotton cloth, then with a clean and dry white  
cotton cloth; you may also use Motorcraft Dash & Vinyl Cleaner  
(ZC-38-A) on the instrument panel and interior trim areas.  
Avoid cleaners or polishes that increase the gloss of the upper portion  
of the instrument panel. The dull finish in this area helps protect the  
driver from undesirable windshield reflection.  
216  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
Be certain to wash or wipe your hands clean if you have been in  
contact with certain products such as insect repellent and suntan  
lotion in order to avoid possible damage to the interior painted  
surfaces.  
Do not use household or glass cleaners as these may damage the  
finish of the instrument panel, interior trim and cluster lens.  
WARNING: Do not use chemical solvents or strong detergents  
when cleaning the steering wheel or instrument panel to avoid  
contamination of the airbag system.  
If a staining liquid like coffee/juice has been spilled on the instrument  
panel or on interior trim surfaces, clean as follows:  
1. Wipe up spilled liquid using a clean, white, cotton cloth.  
2. Apply Motorcraft Deluxe Leather and Vinyl Cleaner (ZC-11-A) [In  
Canada use Motorcraft Multi-Purpose Cleaner (CXC-101)] to the wiped  
area and spread around evenly.  
3. Apply more Motorcraft cleaner to a clean, white, cotton cloth and  
press the cloth onto the soiled area–allow this to set at room  
temperature for 30 minutes.  
4. Remove the soaked cloth, and if it is not soiled badly, use this cloth to  
clean the area by using a rubbing motion for 60 seconds.  
5. Following this, wipe area dry with a clean, white, cotton cloth.  
INTERIOR  
For fabric, carpets, cloth seats, safety belts and seats equipped with side  
airbags:  
Remove dust and loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner.  
Remove light stains and soil with Motorcraft Professional Strength  
Carpet & Upholstery Cleaner (ZC-54).  
If grease or tar is present on the material, spot-clean the area first  
with Motorcraft Spot and Stain Remover (ZC-14). In Canada, use  
Motorcraft Multi-Purpose Cleaner (CXC-101).  
If a ring forms on the fabric after spot cleaning, clean the entire area  
immediately (but do not oversaturate) or the ring will set.  
Do not use household cleaning products or glass cleaners, which can  
stain and discolor the fabric and affect the flame retardant abilities of  
the seat materials.  
217  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
WARNING: Do not use cleaning solvents, bleach or dye on the  
vehicle’s safety belts, as these actions may weaken the belt  
webbing.  
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with seat-mounted airbags, do  
not use chemical solvents or strong detergents. Such products  
could contaminate the side-airbag system and affect performance of  
the side airbag in a collision.  
LEATHER SEATS (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your leather seating surfaces have a clear, protective coating over the  
leather.  
For routine cleaning, wipe the surface with a soft, damp cloth. For  
more thorough cleaning, wipe the surface with a mild soap and water  
solution. In Canada, use Motorcraft Vinyl Cleaner (CXC-93). Dry the  
area with a soft cloth.  
If the leather cannot be completely cleaned using a mild soap and  
water solution, the leather may be cleaned using a commercially  
available cleaning product designed for automotive leather.  
Do not use household cleaning products, alcohol solutions, solvents or  
cleaners intended for rubber, vinyl and plastics, or oil/petroleum-based  
leather conditioners. These products may cause premature wearing of  
the clear, protective coating.  
Note: In some instances, color or dye transfer can occur when wet  
clothing comes in contact with leather upholstery. If this occurs, the  
leather should be cleaned immediately to avoid permanent staining.  
UNDERBODY  
Flush the complete underside of your vehicle frequently. Keep body and  
door drain holes free from packed dirt.  
218  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cleaning  
FORD AND LINCOLN MERCURY CAR CARE PRODUCTS  
Your Ford or Lincoln Mercury authorized dealer has many quality  
products available to clean your vehicle and protect its finishes. These  
quality products have been specifically engineered to fulfill your  
automotive needs; they are custom designed to complement the style  
and appearance of your vehicle. Each product is made from high quality  
materials that meet or exceed rigid specifications. For best results, use  
the following products or products of equivalent quality:  
Motorcraft Bug and Tar Remover (ZC-42)  
Motorcraft Car Wash (Canada only) (CXC-83)  
Motorcraft Custom Bright Metal Cleaner (ZC-15)  
Motorcraft Custom Clear Coat Polish (ZC-8-A)  
Motorcraft Custom Vinyl Protectant (ZC-40-A)  
Motorcraft Dash and Vinyl Cleaner (ZC-38-A)  
Motorcraft Deluxe Leather and Vinyl Cleaner (U.S. only) (ZC-11-A)  
Motorcraft Leather Care Kit (U.S. only) (ZC-11-D)  
Motorcraft Detail Wash (ZC-3-A)  
Motorcraft Dusting Cloth (ZC-24)  
Motorcraft Engine Shampoo and Degreaser (U.S. only) (ZC-20)  
Motorcraft Engine Shampoo (Canada only) (CXC-66-A)  
Motorcraft Multi-Purpose Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-101)  
Motorcraft Premium Glass Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-100)  
Motorcraft Premium Liquid Wax (ZC-53-A)  
Motorcraft Premium Windshield Washer Concentrate (U.S. only)  
(ZC-32-A)  
Motorcraft Professional Strength Carpet & Upholstery Cleaner (ZC-54)  
Motorcraft Spot and Stain Remover (U.S. only) (ZC-14)  
Motorcraft Tire Clean and Shine (ZC-28)  
Motorcraft Triple Clean (U.S. only) (ZC-13)  
Motorcraft Ultra-Clear Spray Glass Cleaner (ZC-23)  
Motorcraft Vinyl Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-93)  
Motorcraft Wash and Wax (Canada only) (CXC-95)  
Motorcraft Wheel and Tire Cleaner (ZC-37-A)  
219  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
SERVICE RECOMMENDATIONS  
To help you service your vehicle, we provide scheduled maintenance  
information which makes tracking routine service easy.  
If your vehicle requires professional service, your authorized dealer can  
provide the necessary parts and service. Check your Warranty  
Guide/Customer Information Guide to find out which parts and  
services are covered.  
Use only recommended fuels, lubricants, fluids and service parts  
conforming to specifications. Motorcraft parts are designed and built to  
provide the best performance in your vehicle.  
PRECAUTIONS WHEN SERVICING YOUR VEHICLE  
Be especially careful when inspecting or servicing your vehicle.  
Do not work on a hot engine.  
When the engine is running, make sure that loose clothing, jewelry or  
long hair does not get caught in moving parts.  
Do not work on a vehicle with the engine running in an enclosed  
space, unless you are sure you have enough ventilation.  
Keep all open flames and other burning (cigarettes) material away  
from the battery and all fuel related parts.  
If you disconnect the battery, the engine must “relearn” its idle condition  
before your vehicle will drive properly, as explained in Battery in this  
section.  
Working with the engine off  
Automatic transmission:  
1. Set the parking brake and shift to P (Park).  
2. Turn off the engine and remove the key.  
3. Block the wheels.  
Manual transmission:  
1. Set the parking brake, depress the clutch and place the gearshift in 1  
(First).  
2. Turn off the engine and remove the key.  
3. Block the wheels.  
220  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Working with the engine on  
Automatic transmission:  
1. Set the parking brake and shift to P (Park).  
2. Block the wheels.  
Manual transmission:  
1. Set the parking brake, depress the clutch pedal, place the gearshift in  
N (Neutral), and release the clutch pedal.  
2. Block the wheels.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of vehicle damage and/or  
personal burn injuries, do not start your engine with the air  
cleaner removed and do not remove it while the engine is running.  
OPENING THE HOOD  
1. Inside the vehicle, pull the hood  
release handle located under the  
instrument panel.  
221  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
2. Go to the front of the vehicle and  
locate the auxiliary latch centered  
under the front of the hood and  
then release it by pushing the  
auxiliary latch to the left.  
3. Lift the hood and locate the prop  
rod on the passenger side of the  
vehicle near the fender. Support the  
hood with the prop rod.  
222  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
IDENTIFYING COMPONENTS IN THE ENGINE COMPARTMENT  
1. Engine oil filler cap  
2. Brake/Clutch fluid reservoir  
3. Power Distribution box  
4. Battery  
5. Air Filter  
6. Automatic transmission fluid dipstick (if equipped)  
7. Engine oil dipstick  
8. Power steering fluid reservoir  
9. Engine coolant reservoir  
10. Windshield washer fluid reservoir  
223  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUID  
Add fluid to fill the reservoir if the  
level is low. In very cold weather, do  
not fill the reservoir completely.  
Only use a washer fluid that meets  
Ford specification WSB-M8B16-A2.  
Do not use any special washer fluid  
such as windshield water repellent  
type fluid or bug wash. They may  
cause squeaking, chatter noise, streaking and smearing. Refer to the  
Maintenance product specifications and capacities section in this  
chapter.  
State or local regulations on volatile organic compounds may restrict the  
use of methanol, a common windshield washer antifreeze additive.  
Washer fluids containing non-methanol antifreeze agents should be used  
only if they provide cold weather protection without damaging the  
vehicle’s paint finish, wiper blades or washer system.  
WARNING: If you operate your vehicle in temperatures below  
40°F (5°C), use washer fluid with antifreeze protection. Failure  
to use washer fluid with antifreeze protection in cold weather could  
result in impaired windshield vision and increase the risk of injury or  
accident.  
Note: Do not put washer fluid in the engine coolant reservoir. Washer  
fluid placed in the cooling system may harm engine and cooling system  
components.  
CHANGING THE WIPER BLADES  
1. Pull the wiper blade and arm  
away from the glass. Turn the blade  
at a right angle to the arm. Push the  
lock tab (A) to release the blade  
from the arm loop and pull the  
blade down toward the windshield  
to remove it from the arm.  
2. Attach the new blade to the arm  
loop and pull it into place until a  
click is heard.  
Replace wiper blades at least once per year for optimum performance.  
224  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Poor wiper quality can be improved by cleaning the wiper blades and the  
windshield. Refer to Windows and wiper blades in the Cleaning  
chapter.  
To prolong the life of the wiper blades, it is highly recommended to  
scrape off the ice on the windshield before turning on the wipers. The  
layer of ice has many sharp edges and can damage the micro edge of the  
wiper rubber element.  
ENGINE OIL  
Checking the engine oil  
Refer to the scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate  
intervals for checking the engine oil.  
1. Make sure the vehicle is on level ground.  
2. Turn the engine off and wait 15 minutes for the oil to drain into the  
oil pan.  
3. Set the parking brake and ensure the gearshift is securely latched in P  
(automatic transmission) or 1st (manual transmission).  
4. Open the hood. Protect yourself from engine heat.  
5. Locate and carefully remove the engine oil level dipstick.  
6. Wipe the dipstick clean. Insert the dipstick fully, then remove it again.  
If the oil level is between the  
MIN and MAX marks, the oil  
level is acceptable. DO NOT  
ADD OIL.  
If the oil level is below the MIN  
mark, add enough engine oil to  
raise the level within the MIN and  
MAX range. Refer to Adding  
engine oil in this chapter.  
Oil levels above MAX mark  
may cause engine damage. If  
the engine is overfilled, some oil  
must be removed from the engine  
by an authorized dealer.  
7. Put the dipstick back in and ensure it is fully seated.  
Adding engine oil  
1. Check the engine oil. For instructions, refer to Checking the engine  
oil in this chapter.  
225  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
2. If the engine oil level is not within the normal range, add only certified  
engine oil of the recommended viscosity. Remove the engine oil filler cap  
and use a funnel to pour the engine oil into the opening.  
3. Recheck the engine oil level. Make sure the oil level is not above the  
MAX mark on the engine oil level dipstick.  
4. Install the dipstick and ensure it is fully seated.  
5. Fully install the engine oil filler cap by turning the filler cap clockwise  
tightly until clicks are heard, or until it is snug.  
To avoid possible oil loss, DO NOT operate the vehicle with the  
engine oil level dipstick and/or the engine oil filler cap removed.  
Engine oil and filter recommendations  
Look for this certification  
trademark.  
Use SAE 5W-20 engine oil  
Only use oils “Certified For Gasoline Engines” by the American  
Petroleum Institute (API). An oil with this trademark symbol conforms  
to the current engine and emission system protection standards and fuel  
economy requirements of the International Lubricant Standardization and  
Approval Committee (ILSAC), comprised of U.S. and Japanese  
automobile manufacturers.  
To protect your engine and engine’s warranty, use Motorcraft SAE 5W-20  
or an equivalent SAE 5W-20 oil meeting Ford specification  
WSS-M2C930-A. SAE 5W-20 oil provides optimum fuel economy and  
durability performance meeting all requirements for your  
vehicle’s engine. Refer to Maintenance product specifications and  
capacities later in this section for more information.  
Do not use supplemental engine oil additives, cleaners or other engine  
treatments. They are unnecessary and could lead to engine damage that  
is not covered by Ford warranty.  
226  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Change your engine oil and filter according to the appropriate schedule  
listed in the scheduled maintenance information.  
Ford production and Motorcraft replacement oil filters are designed for  
added engine protection and long life. If a replacement oil filter is used  
that does not meet Ford material and design specifications, start-up  
engine noises or knock may be experienced.  
It is recommended you use the appropriate Motorcraft oil filter or  
another with equivalent performance for your engine application.  
BATTERY  
Your vehicle is equipped with a  
Motorcraft maintenance-free battery  
which normally does not require  
additional water during its life of  
service.  
If your battery has a cover/shield, make sure it is reinstalled  
after the battery has been cleaned or replaced.  
For longer, trouble-free operation, keep the top of the battery clean and  
dry. Also, make certain the battery cables are always tightly fastened to  
the battery terminals.  
If you see any corrosion on the battery or terminals, remove the cables  
from the terminals and clean with a wire brush. You can neutralize the  
acid with a solution of baking soda and water.  
It is recommended that the negative battery cable terminal be  
disconnected from the battery if you plan to store your vehicle for an  
extended period of time. This will minimize the discharge of your battery  
during storage.  
Note: Electrical or electronic accessories or components added to  
the vehicle by the dealer or the owner may adversely affect  
battery performance and durability.  
WARNING: Batteries normally produce explosive gases which  
can cause personal injury. Therefore, do not allow flames, sparks  
or lighted substances to come near the battery. When working near the  
battery, always shield your face and protect your eyes. Always provide  
proper ventilation.  
227  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: When lifting a plastic-cased battery, excessive  
pressure on the end walls could cause acid to flow through the  
vent caps, resulting in personal injury and/or damage to the vehicle or  
battery. Lift the battery with a battery carrier or with your hands on  
opposite corners.  
WARNING: Keep batteries out of reach of children. Batteries  
contain sulfuric acid. Avoid contact with skin, eyes or clothing.  
Shield your eyes when working near the battery to protect against  
possible splashing of acid solution. In case of acid contact with skin or  
eyes, flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and  
get prompt medical attention. If acid is swallowed, call a physician  
immediately.  
WARNING: Battery posts, terminals and related accessories  
contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands after handling.  
Because your vehicle’s engine is electronically controlled by a computer,  
some control conditions are maintained by power from the battery. When  
the battery is disconnected or a new battery is installed, the engine must  
relearn its idle and fuel trim strategy for optimum driveability and  
performance. To begin this process:  
1. With the vehicle at a complete stop, set the parking brake.  
2. Put the gearshift in P (Park) (automatic transmission) or the neutral  
position (manual transmission), turn off all accessories and start the  
engine.  
3. Run the engine until it reaches normal operating temperature.  
4. Allow the engine to idle for at least one minute.  
5. Turn the A/C on and allow the engine to idle for at least one minute.  
6. Drive the vehicle to complete the relearning process.  
The vehicle may need to be driven 10 miles (16 km) or more to  
relearn the idle and fuel trim strategy.  
If you do not allow the engine to relearn its idle trim, the idle  
quality of your vehicle may be adversely affected until the idle  
trim is eventually relearned.  
When the battery is disconnected or a new battery installed, the  
transmission must learn its adaptive strategy. As a result of this, the  
228  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
transmission may shift firmly. This operation is considered normal and  
will fully update transmission operation to its optimum shift feel.  
If the battery has been disconnected or a new battery has been installed,  
the clock and the preset radio stations must be reset once the battery is  
reconnected.  
Always dispose of automotive  
batteries in a responsible manner.  
Follow your local authorized  
standards for disposal. Call your  
local authorized recycling center  
to find out more about recycling  
automotive batteries.  
RECYCLE  
ENGINE COOLANT  
Checking engine coolant  
The concentration and level of engine coolant should be checked at the  
intervals listed in scheduled maintenance information. The coolant  
concentration should be maintained at 50/50 coolant and distilled water,  
which equates to a freeze point of -34°F (-36°C). Coolant concentration  
testing is possible with a hydrometer or antifreeze tester (such as the  
Rotunda Battery and Antifreeze Tester). The level of coolant should be  
maintained at the “FULL COLD” level or within the “COLD FILL  
RANGE” in the coolant reservoir. If the level falls below, add coolant per  
the instructions in the Adding engine coolant section.  
Your vehicle was factory-filled with a 50/50 engine coolant and water  
concentration. If the concentration of coolant falls below 40% or above  
60%, the engine parts could become damaged or not work properly. A  
50/50 mixture of coolant and water provides the following:  
Freeze protection down to -34°F (-36°C).  
Boiling protection up to 265°F (129°C).  
Protection against rust and other forms of corrosion.  
Proper function of calibrated gauges.  
229  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
When the engine is cold, check the  
level of the engine coolant in the  
reservoir.  
The engine coolant should be at the “FULL COLD” level or within the  
“COLD FILL RANGE” as listed on the engine coolant reservoir  
(depending upon application).  
Refer to scheduled maintenance information for service interval  
schedules.  
Be sure to read and understand Precautions when servicing your  
vehicle in this chapter.  
If the engine coolant has not been checked at the recommended interval,  
the engine coolant reservoir may become low or empty. If the reservoir is  
low or empty, add engine coolant to the reservoir. Refer to Adding  
engine coolant in this chapter.  
Note: Automotive fluids are not interchangeable; do not use engine  
coolant, antifreeze or windshield washer fluid outside of its specified  
function and vehicle location.  
Adding engine coolant  
When adding coolant, make sure it is a 50/50 mixture of engine coolant  
and distilled water. When the engine is cool, add the mixture to the  
coolant reservoir until the appropriate fill level is obtained.  
WARNING: Do not add engine coolant when the engine is hot.  
Steam and scalding liquids released from a hot cooling system  
can burn you badly. Also, you can be burned if you spill coolant on hot  
engine parts.  
WARNING: Do not put engine coolant in the windshield washer  
fluid container. If sprayed on the windshield, engine coolant  
could make it difficult to see through the windshield.  
230  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Add Motorcraft Premium Gold Engine Coolant or equivalent  
meeting Ford specification WSS-M97B51-A1. Refer to  
Maintenance product specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
Note: Use of Motorcraft Cooling System Stop Leak Pellets or an  
equivalent product meeting Ford specification WSS-M99B37-B6, may  
darken the color of Motorcraft Premium Gold Engine Coolant from  
yellow to golden tan.  
Do not add/mix an orange-colored, extended life coolant such  
as Motorcraft Specialty Orange Engine Coolant, meeting Ford  
specification WSS-M97B44-D, or DEX-COOLbrand with the  
factory-filled coolant. Mixing Motorcraft Specialty Orange Engine  
Coolant or any orange-colored extended life product such as  
DEX-COOLbrand with your factory filled coolant can result in  
degraded corrosion protection.  
A large amount of water without engine coolant may be added, in case  
of emergency, to reach a vehicle service location. In this instance, the  
cooling system must be drained and refilled with a 50/50 mixture of  
engine coolant and distilled water as soon as possible. Water alone  
(without engine coolant) can cause engine damage from corrosion,  
overheating or freezing.  
Do not use alcohol, methanol, brine or any engine coolants  
mixed with alcohol or methanol antifreeze (coolant). Alcohol and  
other liquids can cause engine damage from overheating or freezing.  
Do not add extra inhibitors or additives to the coolant. These  
can be harmful and compromise the corrosion protection of the engine  
coolant.  
For vehicles with overflow coolant systems with a non-pressurized cap  
on the coolant recovery system, add coolant to the coolant recovery  
reservoir when the engine is cool. Add the proper mixture of coolant and  
water to the “FULL COLD” level. For all other vehicles which have a  
coolant degas system with a pressurized cap, or if it is necessary to  
remove the coolant pressure relief cap on the radiator of a vehicle with  
an overflow system, follow these steps to add engine coolant.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of personal injury, make sure the  
engine is cool before unscrewing the coolant pressure relief cap.  
The cooling system is under pressure; steam and hot liquid can come  
out forcefully when the cap is loosened slightly.  
231  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Add the proper mixture of coolant and water to the cooling system by  
following these steps:  
1. Before you begin, turn the engine off and let it cool.  
2. When the engine is cool, wrap a thick cloth around the coolant  
pressure relief cap on the coolant reservoir (a translucent plastic bottle).  
Slowly turn cap counterclockwise (left) until pressure begins to release.  
3. Step back while the pressure releases.  
4. When you are sure that all the pressure has been released, use the  
cloth to turn it counterclockwise and remove the cap.  
5. Fill the coolant reservoir slowly with the proper coolant mixture, to  
within the “COLD FILL RANGE” or the “FULL COLD” level on the  
reservoir. If you removed the radiator cap in an overflow system, fill the  
radiator until the coolant is visible and radiator is almost full.  
6. Replace the cap. Turn until tightly installed. Cap must be tightly  
installed to prevent coolant loss.  
After any coolant has been added, check the coolant concentration (refer  
to Checking engine coolant). If the concentration is not 50/50  
(protection to –34°F/–36°C), drain some coolant and adjust the  
concentration. It may take several drains and additions to obtain a 50/50  
coolant concentration.  
Whenever coolant has been added, the coolant level in the coolant  
reservoir should be checked the next few times you drive the vehicle. If  
necessary, add enough 50/50 concentration of engine coolant and  
distilled water to bring the liquid level to the proper level.  
If you have to add more than 1.0 quart (1.0 liter) of engine coolant per  
month, have your authorized dealer check the engine cooling system.  
Your cooling system may have a leak. Operating an engine with a low  
level of coolant can result in engine overheating and possible engine  
damage.  
Recycled engine coolant  
Ford Motor Company does NOT recommend the use of recycled engine  
coolant in vehicles originally equipped with Motorcraft Premium Gold  
Engine Coolant since a Ford-approved recycling process is not yet  
available.  
Used engine coolant should be disposed of in an appropriate  
manner. Follow your community’s regulations and standards for recycling  
and disposing of automotive fluids.  
232  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Coolant refill capacity  
To find out how much fluid your vehicle’s cooling system can hold, refer  
to Maintenance product specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
Fill your engine coolant reservoir as outlined in Adding engine coolant  
in this section.  
Severe climates  
If you drive in extremely cold climates (less than –34°F [–36°C]):  
It may be necessary to increase the coolant concentration  
above 50%.  
NEVER increase the coolant concentration above 60%.  
Increased engine coolant concentrations above 60% will  
decrease the overheat protection characteristics of the engine  
coolant and may cause engine damage.  
Refer to the chart on the coolant container to ensure the  
coolant concentration in your vehicle will provide adequate  
freeze protection at the temperatures in which you drive in the  
winter months.  
If you drive in extremely hot climates:  
It is still necessary to maintain the coolant concentration  
above 40%.  
NEVER decrease the coolant concentration below 40%.  
Decreased engine coolant concentrations below 40% will  
decrease the corrosion protection characteristics of the engine  
coolant and may cause engine damage.  
Decreased engine coolant concentrations below 40% will  
decrease the freeze protection characteristics of the engine  
coolant and may cause engine damage.  
Refer to the chart on the coolant container to ensure the  
coolant concentration in your vehicle will provide adequate  
protection at the temperatures in which you drive.  
Vehicles driven year-round in non-extreme climates should use a 50/50  
mixture of engine coolant and distilled water for optimum cooling system  
and engine protection.  
What you should know about fail-safe cooling  
If the engine coolant supply is depleted, this feature allows the vehicle to  
be driven temporarily before incremental component damage is incurred.  
The “fail-safe” distance depends on ambient temperatures, vehicle load  
and terrain.  
233  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
How fail-safe cooling works  
If the engine begins to overheat:  
The engine coolant temperature gauge will move to the red (hot)  
area.  
The  
(engine coolant temperature) indicator light will illuminate.  
If the engine reaches a preset over-temperature condition, the engine  
will automatically switch to alternating cylinder operation. Each disabled  
cylinder acts as an air pump and cools the engine.  
When this occurs the vehicle will still operate. However:  
The engine power will be limited.  
The air conditioning system will be disabled.  
Continued operation will increase the engine temperature:  
The engine will completely shut down.  
Steering and braking effort will increase.  
Once the engine temperature cools, the engine can be re-started. Take  
your vehicle to an authorized dealer as soon as possible to minimize  
engine damage.  
When fail-safe mode is activated  
You have limited engine power when in the fail-safe mode, so drive the  
vehicle with caution. The vehicle will not be able to maintain high speed  
operation and the engine will run rough. Remember that the engine is  
capable of completely shutting down automatically to prevent engine  
damage, therefore:  
1. Pull off the road as soon as safely possible and turn off the engine.  
2. Arrange for the vehicle to be taken to an authorized dealer.  
3. If this is not possible, wait a short period for the engine to cool.  
4. Check the coolant level and replenish if low.  
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the  
engine is running or hot.  
5. Restart the engine and take your vehicle to an authorized dealer.  
Driving the vehicle without repairing the engine problem  
increases the chance of engine damage. Take your vehicle to an  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
234  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
FUEL FILTER  
Your vehicle is equipped with a lifetime fuel filter that is integrated with  
the fuel tank. Regular maintenance or replacement is not needed.  
WHAT YOU SHOULD KNOW ABOUT AUTOMOTIVE FUELS  
Important safety precautions  
WARNING: Do not overfill the fuel tank. The pressure in an  
overfilled tank may cause leakage and lead to fuel spray and fire.  
WARNING: The fuel system may be under pressure. If the fuel  
filler cap is venting vapor or if you hear a hissing sound, wait  
until it stops before completely removing the fuel filler cap. Otherwise,  
fuel may spray out and injure you or others.  
WARNING: If you do not use the proper fuel filler cap,  
excessive vacuum in the fuel tank may damage the fuel system  
or cause the fuel cap to disengage in a collision, which may result in  
serious personal injury.  
WARNING: Automotive fuels can cause serious injury or death  
if misused or mishandled.  
WARNING: Gasoline may contain benzene, which is a  
cancer-causing agent.  
Observe the following guidelines when handling automotive fuel:  
Extinguish all smoking materials  
and any open flames before  
refueling your vehicle.  
Always turn off the vehicle before  
refueling.  
Automotive fuels can be harmful  
or fatal if swallowed. Fuel such as gasoline is highly toxic and if  
swallowed can cause death or permanent injury. If fuel is swallowed,  
call a physician immediately, even if no symptoms are immediately  
apparent. The toxic effects of fuel may not be visible for hours.  
235  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Avoid inhaling fuel vapors. Inhaling too much fuel vapor of any kind  
can lead to eye and respiratory tract irritation. In severe cases,  
excessive or prolonged breathing of fuel vapor can cause serious  
illness and permanent injury.  
Avoid getting fuel liquid in your eyes. If fuel is splashed in the eyes,  
remove contact lenses (if worn), flush with water for 15 minutes and  
seek medical attention. Failure to seek proper medical attention could  
lead to permanent injury.  
Fuels can also be harmful if absorbed through the skin. If fuel is  
splashed on the skin and/or clothing, promptly remove contaminated  
clothing and wash skin thoroughly with soap and water. Repeated or  
prolonged skin contact with fuel liquid or vapor causes skin irritation.  
Be particularly careful if you are taking “Antabuse” or other forms of  
disulfiram for the treatment of alcoholism. Breathing gasoline vapors,  
or skin contact could cause an adverse reaction. In sensitive  
individuals, serious personal injury or sickness may result. If fuel is  
splashed on the skin, promptly wash skin thoroughly with soap and  
water. Consult a physician immediately if you experience an adverse  
reaction.  
WARNING: When refueling always shut the engine off and  
never allow sparks or open flames near the filler neck. Never  
smoke while refueling. Fuel vapor is extremely hazardous under certain  
conditions. Care should be taken to avoid inhaling excess fumes.  
WARNING: The flow of fuel through a fuel pump nozzle can  
produce static electricity, which can cause a fire if fuel is  
pumped into an ungrounded fuel container.  
236  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Refueling  
WARNING: Fuel vapor burns violently and a fuel fire can cause  
severe injuries. To help avoid injuries to you and others:  
Read and follow all the instructions on the pump island;  
Turn off your engine when you are refueling;  
Do not smoke if you are near fuel or refueling your vehicle;  
Keep sparks, flames and smoking materials away from fuel;  
Stay outside your vehicle and do not leave the fuel pump unattended  
when refueling your vehicle — this is against the law in some places;  
Keep children away from the fuel pump; never let children pump  
fuel.  
Use the following guidelines to avoid electrostatic charge build-up when  
filling an ungrounded fuel container:  
Place approved fuel container on the ground.  
DO NOT fill a fuel container while it is in the vehicle (including the  
cargo area).  
Keep the fuel pump nozzle in contact with the fuel container while  
filling.  
DO NOT use a device that would hold the fuel pump handle in the fill  
position.  
Fuel filler cap  
When fueling your vehicle:  
1. Turn the engine off.  
2. Carefully turn the filler cap counterclockwise until it spins off.  
3. Pull to remove the cap from the fuel filler pipe.  
4. To install the cap, align the tabs on the cap with the notches on the  
filler pipe.  
5. Turn the filler cap clockwise 1/4 of a turn until at least one click is  
heard.  
If the check fuel cap light  
or a “check fuel cap” message comes on,  
the fuel filler cap may not be properly installed. The light or message can  
come on after several driving events after you’ve refueled your vehicle.  
At the next opportunity, safely pull off of the road, remove the fuel filler  
cap, align the cap properly and reinstall it. The check fuel cap  
237  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
light  
or “check fuel cap” message may not reset immediately; it may  
or “check fuel  
take several driving cycles for the check fuel cap light  
cap” message to turn off. A driving cycle consists of an engine start-up  
(after four or more hours with the engine off) followed by city and  
highway driving.  
Continuing to drive with the check fuel cap light  
or “check fuel cap”  
message on may cause the light to turn on as well.  
If you must replace the fuel filler cap, replace it with a fuel filler  
cap that is designed for your vehicle. The customer warranty may  
be void for any damage to the fuel tank or fuel system if the  
correct genuine Ford, Motorcraft or other certified fuel filler cap  
is not used.  
WARNING: The fuel system may be under pressure. If the fuel  
filler cap is venting vapor or if you hear a hissing sound, wait  
until it stops before completely removing the fuel filler cap. Otherwise,  
fuel may spray out and injure you or others.  
WARNING: If you do not use the proper fuel filler cap,  
excessive vacuum in the fuel tank may damage the fuel system  
or cause the fuel cap to disengage in a collision, which may result in  
personal injury.  
Choosing the right fuel  
Use only UNLEADED fuel or UNLEADED fuel blended with a maximum  
of 10% ethanol. Do not use fuel ethanol (E85), diesel, methanol, leaded  
fuel or any other fuel. The use of leaded fuel is prohibited by law and  
could damage your vehicle.  
Your vehicle was not designed to use fuel or fuel additives with metallic  
compounds, including manganese-based additives.  
238  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Note: Use of any fuel other than those recommended may cause  
powertrain damage, a loss of vehicle performance, and repairs may not  
be covered under warranty.  
Octane recommendations  
Your vehicle is designed to use  
“Regular” unleaded gasoline with a  
pump (R+M)/2 octane rating of 87.  
87  
We do not recommend the use of  
(R+M)/2 METHOD  
gasolines labeled as “Regular” in  
high altitude areas that are sold with octane ratings less than 87.  
Do not be concerned if your engine sometimes knocks lightly. However, if  
it knocks heavily under most driving conditions while you are using fuel  
with the recommended octane rating, see your authorized dealer to  
prevent any engine damage.  
Fuel quality  
If you are experiencing starting, rough idle or hesitation driveability  
problems, try a different brand of unleaded gasoline. “Premium”  
unleaded gasoline is not recommended for vehicles designed to use  
“Regular” unleaded gasoline because it may cause these problems to  
become more pronounced. If the problems persist, see your authorized  
dealer.  
Do not add aftermarket fuel additive products to your fuel tank. It  
should not be necessary to add any aftermarket products to your fuel  
tank if you continue to use high quality fuel of the recommended octane  
rating. These products have not been approved for your engine and  
could cause damage to the fuel system. Repairs to correct the effects of  
using an aftermarket product in your fuel may not be covered by your  
warranty.  
Many of the world’s automakers approved the World-Wide Fuel Charter  
that recommends gasoline specifications to provide improved  
performance and emission control system protection for your vehicle.  
Gasolines that meet the World-Wide Fuel Charter should be used when  
available. Ask your fuel supplier about gasolines that meet the  
World-Wide Fuel Charter.  
Cleaner air  
Ford endorses the use of reformulated “cleaner-burning” gasolines to  
improve air quality, per the recommendations in the Choosing the right  
fuel section.  
239  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Running out of fuel  
Avoid running out of fuel because this situation may have an adverse  
effect on powertrain components.  
If you have run out of fuel:  
You may need to cycle the ignition from off to on several times after  
refueling to allow the fuel system to pump the fuel from the tank to  
the engine. On restarting, cranking time will take a few seconds longer  
than normal.  
Normally, adding 1 gallon (3.8L) of fuel is enough to restart the  
engine. If the vehicle is out of fuel and on a steep grade, more than  
1 gallon (3.8L) may be required.  
The Service engine soon  
indicator may come on. For more  
indicator, refer to  
information on the Service engine soon  
Warning lights and chimes in the Instrument Cluster chapter.  
ESSENTIALS OF GOOD FUEL ECONOMY  
Measuring techniques  
Your best source of information about actual fuel economy is you, the  
driver. You must gather information as accurately and consistently as  
possible. Fuel expense, frequency of fill-ups or fuel gauge readings are  
NOT accurate as a measure of fuel economy. We do not recommend  
taking fuel economy measurements during the first 1,000 miles  
(1,600 km) of driving (engine break-in period). You will get a more  
accurate measurement after 2,000 miles–3,000 miles (3,000 km–5,000  
km).  
Filling the tank  
The advertised fuel capacity of the fuel tank on your vehicle is equal to  
the rated refill capacity of the fuel tank as listed in the Maintenance  
product specifications and capacities section of this chapter.  
The advertised capacity is the amount of the indicated capacity and the  
empty reserve combined. Indicated capacity is the difference in the  
amount of fuel in a full tank and a tank when the fuel gauge indicates  
empty. Empty reserve is the small amount of fuel remaining in the fuel  
tank after the fuel gauge indicates empty.  
The amount of usable fuel in the empty reserve varies and should  
not be relied upon to increase driving range. When refueling your  
vehicle after the fuel gauge indicates empty, you might not be  
240  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
able to refuel the full amount of the advertised capacity of the  
fuel tank due to the empty reserve still present in the tank.  
For consistent results when filling the fuel tank:  
Turn the engine/ignition switch to the off position prior to refueling,  
an error in the reading will result if the engine is left running.  
Use the same filling rate setting (low — medium — high) each time  
the tank is filled.  
Allow no more than two automatic click-offs when filling.  
Always use fuel with the recommended octane rating.  
Use a known quality gasoline, preferably a national brand.  
Use the same side of the same pump and have the vehicle facing the  
same direction each time you fill up.  
Have the vehicle loading and distribution the same every time.  
Your results will be most accurate if your filling method is consistent.  
Calculating fuel economy  
1. Fill the fuel tank completely and record the initial odometer reading  
(in miles or kilometers).  
2. Each time you fill the tank, record the amount of fuel added (in  
gallons or liters).  
3. After at least three to five tank fill-ups, fill the fuel tank and record  
the current odometer reading.  
4. Subtract your initial odometer reading from the current odometer  
reading.  
5. Follow one of the simple calculations in order to determine fuel  
economy:  
Calculation 1: Divide total miles traveled by total gallons used.  
Calculation 2: Multiply liters used by 100, then divide by total  
kilometers traveled.  
Keep a record for at least one month and record the type of driving (city  
or highway). This will provide an accurate estimate of the vehicle’s fuel  
economy under current driving conditions. Additionally, keeping records  
during summer and winter will show how temperature impacts fuel  
economy. In general, lower temperatures give lower fuel economy.  
Driving style — good driving and fuel economy habits  
Give consideration to the lists that follow and you may be able to change  
a number of variables and improve your fuel economy.  
241  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Habits  
Smooth, moderate operation can yield up to 10% savings in fuel.  
Steady speeds without stopping will usually give the best fuel  
economy.  
Idling for long periods of time (greater than one minute) may waste  
fuel.  
Anticipate stopping; slowing down may eliminate the need to stop.  
Sudden or hard accelerations may reduce fuel economy.  
Slow down gradually.  
Driving at reasonable speeds (traveling at 55 mph [88 km/h] uses 15%  
less fuel than traveling at 65 mph [105 km/h]).  
Revving the engine before turning it off may reduce fuel economy.  
Using the air conditioner or defroster may reduce fuel economy.  
You may want to turn off the speed control in hilly terrain if  
unnecessary shifting between the top gears occurs. Unnecessary  
shifting of this type could result in reduced fuel economy.  
Warming up a vehicle on cold mornings is not required and may  
reduce fuel economy.  
Resting your foot on the brake pedal while driving may reduce fuel  
economy.  
Combine errands and minimize stop-and-go driving.  
Maintenance  
Keep tires properly inflated and use only recommended size.  
Operating a vehicle with the wheels out of alignment will reduce fuel  
economy.  
Use recommended engine oil. Refer to Maintenance product  
specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
Perform all regularly scheduled maintenance items. Follow the  
recommended maintenance schedule and owner maintenance checks  
found in scheduled maintenance information.  
Conditions  
Heavily loading a vehicle or towing a trailer may reduce fuel economy  
at any speed.  
Carrying unnecessary weight may reduce fuel economy (approximately  
1 mpg [0.4 km/L] is lost for every 400 lb [180 kg] of weight carried).  
242  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Adding certain accessories to your vehicle (for example bug  
deflectors, rollbars/light bars, running boards, ski/luggage racks) may  
reduce fuel economy.  
Using fuel blended with alcohol may lower fuel economy.  
Fuel economy may decrease with lower temperatures during the first  
8–10 miles (12–16 km) of driving.  
Driving on flat terrain offers improved fuel economy as compared to  
driving on hilly terrain.  
Transmissions give their best fuel economy when operated in the top  
cruise gear and with steady pressure on the gas pedal.  
Close windows for high speed driving.  
EPA fuel economy estimates  
Every new vehicle should have a window sticker containing EPA fuel  
economy estimates. Contact your authorized dealer if the window sticker  
is not supplied with your vehicle. The EPA fuel economy estimates  
should be your guide for the fuel economy comparisons with other  
vehicles. Your fuel economy may vary depending upon the method of  
operation and conditions.  
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM  
Your vehicle is equipped with various emission control components and a  
catalytic converter which will enable your vehicle to comply with  
applicable exhaust emission standards. To make sure that the catalytic  
converter and other emission control components continue to work  
properly:  
Use only the specified fuel listed.  
Avoid running out of fuel.  
Do not turn off the ignition while your vehicle is moving, especially at  
high speeds.  
Have the items listed in scheduled maintenance information  
performed according to the specified schedule.  
The scheduled maintenance items listed in scheduled maintenance  
information are essential to the life and performance of your vehicle  
and to its emissions system.  
If other than Ford, Motorcraft or Ford-authorized parts are used for  
maintenance replacements or for service of components affecting  
emission control, such non-Ford parts should be equivalent to genuine  
Ford Motor Company parts in performance and durability.  
243  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle in dry grass  
or other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up the  
engine compartment and exhaust system, which can start a fire.  
Illumination of the Service engine soon  
indicator, charging system  
warning light or the temperature warning light, fluid leaks, strange odors,  
smoke or loss of engine power could indicate that the emission control  
system is not working properly.  
An improperly operating or damaged exhaust system may allow exhaust  
to enter the vehicle. Have a damaged or improperly operating exhaust  
system inspected and repaired immediately.  
WARNING: Exhaust leaks may result in entry of harmful and  
potentially lethal fumes into the passenger compartment.  
Do not make any unauthorized changes to your vehicle or engine. By  
law, vehicle owners and anyone who manufactures, repairs, services,  
sells, leases, trades vehicles, or supervises a fleet of vehicles are not  
permitted to intentionally remove an emission control device or prevent  
it from working. Information about your vehicle’s emission system is on  
the Vehicle Emission Control Information Decal located on or near the  
engine. This decal also lists engine displacement.  
Please consult your Warranty Guide/Customer Information Guide for  
complete emission warranty information.  
On board diagnostics (OBD-II)  
Your vehicle is equipped with a computer that monitors the engine’s  
emission control system. This system is commonly known as the On  
Board Diagnostics System (OBD-II). The OBD-II system protects the  
environment by ensuring that your vehicle continues to meet  
government emission standards. The OBD-II system also assists your  
authorized dealer in properly servicing your vehicle. When the Service  
engine soon  
a malfunction. Temporary malfunctions may cause the Service engine  
soon indicator to illuminate. Examples are:  
indicator illuminates, the OBD-II system has detected  
1. The vehicle has run out of fuel—the engine may misfire or run poorly.  
2. Poor fuel quality or water in the fuel—the engine may misfire or run  
poorly.  
3. The fuel cap may not have been securely tightened. See Fuel filler  
cap in this chapter.  
244  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
4. Driving through deep water—the electrical system may be wet.  
These temporary malfunctions can be corrected by filling the fuel tank  
with good quality fuel, properly tightening the fuel cap or letting the  
electrical system dry out. After three driving cycles without these or any  
other temporary malfunctions present, the Service engine soon  
indicator should stay off the next time the engine is started. A driving  
cycle consists of a cold engine startup followed by mixed city/highway  
driving. No additional vehicle service is required.  
If the Service engine soon  
indicator remains on, have your vehicle  
serviced at the first available opportunity. Although some malfunctions  
detected by the OBD-II may not have symptoms that are apparent,  
continued driving with the Service engine soon  
indicator on can  
result in increased emissions, lower fuel economy, reduced engine and  
transmission smoothness, and lead to more costly repairs.  
Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) testing  
Some state/provincial and local governments may have  
Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) programs to inspect the emission control  
equipment on your vehicle. Failure to pass this inspection could prevent  
you from getting a vehicle registration. Your vehicle may not pass the I/M  
test if the Service engine soon  
indicator is on or not working  
properly (bulb is burned out), or if the OBD-II system has determined  
that some of the emission control systems have not been properly  
checked. In this case, the vehicle is considered not ready for I/M testing.  
If the Service engine soon  
indicator is on or the bulb does not  
work, the vehicle may need to be serviced. Refer to the On board  
diagnostics (OBD-II) description in this chapter.  
If the vehicle’s engine or transmission has just been serviced, or the  
battery has recently run down or been replaced, the OBD-II system may  
indicate that the vehicle is not ready for I/M testing. To determine if the  
vehicle is ready for I/M testing, turn the ignition key to the on position  
for 15 seconds without cranking the engine. If the Service engine  
soon  
indicator blinks eight times, it means that the vehicle is not  
ready for I/M testing; if the Service engine soon  
indicator stays on  
solid, it means that the vehicle is ready for I/M testing.  
245  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
The OBD-II system is designed to check the emission control system  
during normal driving. A complete check may take several days. If the  
vehicle is not ready for I/M testing, the following driving cycle consisting  
of mixed city and highway driving may be performed:  
15 minutes of steady driving on an expressway/highway followed by  
20 minutes of stop-and-go driving with at least four 30-second idle  
periods.  
Allow the vehicle to sit for at least eight hours without starting the  
engine. Then, start the engine and complete the above driving cycle. The  
engine must warm up to its normal operating temperature. Once started,  
do not turn off the engine until the above driving cycle is complete. If  
the vehicle is still not ready for I/M testing, the above driving cycle will  
have to be repeated.  
POWER STEERING FLUID  
Check the fluid. Refer to the  
scheduled maintenance  
information for service  
maintenance schedules.  
1. Start the engine and let it run  
until it reaches normal operating  
temperature.  
2. Turn the steering wheel left and  
right several times.  
3. Turn the engine off.  
4. Check the fluid level.  
5. If the fluid is below the MIN line, add fluid in small amounts until it  
reaches the correct level (between the MIN and MAX lines). Refer to  
Maintenance product specifications and capacities in this chapter for  
the proper fluid type.  
246  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
BRAKE/CLUTCH FLUID  
Brake and clutch systems are supplied from the same reservoir.  
The fluid level will drop slowly as  
the brakes wear, and will rise when  
the brake components are replaced.  
Fluid levels between the “MIN” and  
“MAX” lines are within the normal  
operating range; there is no need to  
add fluid. If the fluid levels are  
outside of the normal operating  
range the performance of the  
system could be compromised; seek  
service from your authorized dealer  
immediately.  
TRANSMISSION FLUID  
Checking automatic transmission fluid  
Refer to your scheduled maintenance information for scheduled  
intervals for fluid checks and changes. Your transmission does not  
consume fluid. However, the fluid level should be checked if the  
transmission is not working properly, i.e., if the transmission slips or  
shifts slowly or if you notice some sign of fluid leakage.  
Automatic transmission fluid expands when warmed. To obtain an  
accurate fluid check, drive the vehicle until it is warmed up  
(approximately 20 miles [30 km]). If your vehicle has been  
operated for an extended period at high speeds, in city traffic  
during hot weather or pulling a trailer, the vehicle should be  
turned off for about 30 minutes to allow fluid to cool before  
checking.  
1. Drive the vehicle 20 miles (30 km) or until it reaches normal operating  
temperature.  
2. Park the vehicle on a level surface and engage the parking brake.  
3. With the parking brake engaged and your foot on the brake pedal,  
start the engine and move the gearshift lever through all of the gear  
ranges. Allow sufficient time for each gear to engage.  
4. Latch the gearshift lever in P (Park) and leave the engine running.  
5. Remove the dipstick, wiping it clean with a clean, dry lint free rag. If  
necessary, refer to Identifying components in the engine compartment  
in this chapter for the location of the dipstick.  
247  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
6. Install the dipstick making sure it is fully seated in the filler tube.  
7. Remove the dipstick and inspect the fluid level. The fluid should be in  
the designated areas for normal operating temperature.  
Low fluid level  
Do not drive the vehicle if the fluid  
level is at the bottom of the dipstick  
and the outside temperatures are  
above 50°F (10°C).  
Correct fluid level  
The transmission fluid should be checked at normal operating  
temperatures 120°F-140°F (50°C-60°C) on a level surface. The normal  
operating temperature can be reached after approximately 20 miles  
(30 km) of driving.  
The transmission fluid should be in  
this range if at normal operating  
temperature (120°F-140°F  
[50°C-60°C]).  
High fluid level  
Fluid levels above the safe range  
may result in transmission failure.  
An overfill condition of transmission  
fluid may cause shift and/or  
engagement concerns and/or  
possible damage.  
High fluid levels can be caused by an overheating condition.  
Adjusting automatic transmission fluid levels  
Before adding any fluid, make sure the correct type is used. The type of  
fluid used is normally indicated on the dipstick and also in the  
Maintenance product specifications and capacities section in this  
chapter.  
Use of a non-approved automatic transmission fluid may cause  
internal transmission component damage.  
If necessary, add fluid in 1/2 pint (250 mL) increments through the filler  
tube until the level is correct.  
248  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
If an overfill occurs, excess fluid  
should be removed by an authorized  
dealer.  
An overfill condition of  
transmission fluid may cause  
shift and/or engagement concerns and/or possible damage.  
Do not use supplemental transmission fluid additives, treatments or  
cleaning agents. The use of these materials may affect transmission  
operation and result in damage to internal transmission components.  
Checking and adding manual transmission fluid (if equipped)  
1. Clean the filler plug.  
2. Remove the filler plug and  
inspect the fluid level.  
3. Fluid level should be at the  
bottom of the opening.  
4. Add enough fluid through the  
filler opening so that the fluid level  
is at the bottom of the opening.  
5. Install and tighten the fill plug  
securely.  
Use only fluid that meets Ford specifications. Refer to the Maintenance  
product specifications and capacities section in this chapter.  
AIR FILTER  
Refer to scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate  
intervals for changing the air filter element.  
When changing the air filter element, use only the Motorcraft air filter  
element listed. Refer to Motorcraft part numbers in this chapter.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of vehicle damage and/or  
personal burn injuries do not start your engine with the air  
cleaner removed and do not remove it while the engine is running.  
249  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Air filter element (PZEV)  
Your vehicle is equipped with a long life air filter. The air filter is  
designed to last the life of the vehicle. See your authorized dealer or a  
qualified technician for replacement. The technician can check the  
diagnostics system for the possibility of an excessively dirty air filter.  
Changing the air filter element (Non-PZEV only)  
1. Release the clamps that secure  
the air filter housing cover.  
2. Carefully separate the two halves  
of the air filter housing.  
3. Remove the air filter element  
from the air filter housing.  
4. Wipe the air filter housing and  
cover clean to remove any dirt or  
debris and to ensure good sealing.  
5. Install a new air filter element. Be  
careful not to crimp the filter element edges between the air filter  
housing and cover. This could cause filter damage and allow unfiltered  
air to enter the engine if not properly seated.  
6. Replace the air filter housing cover and secure the clamps. Be sure  
that the air cleaner cover tabs are engaged into the slots of the air  
cleaner housing.  
Note: Failure to use the correct air filter element may result in severe  
engine damage. The customer warranty may be void for any damage to  
the engine if the correct air filter element is not used.  
250  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
MOTORCRAFT PART NUMBERS  
Component  
Air filter element  
Oil filter  
2.0L I4 engine  
FA-18901  
FL-9102  
Battery  
Temporary mobility kit refill  
canister  
PCV valve  
Spark plugs  
BXT-96R  
TA-33  
3
4
1Non PZEV only: Failure to use the correct air filter element may result  
in severe engine damage. The customer warranty may be void for any  
damage to the engine if the correct air filter element is not used.  
For PZEV, the air filter is designed to last the life of the vehicle. See  
your authorized dealer or qualified technician for replacement. The  
technician can check the diagnostics system for the possibility of an  
excessively dirty air filter.  
2Only use the specified replacement oil filter. The use of a non-specified  
oil filter can result in engine damage.  
3The PCV valve is a critical emission component. It is one of the items  
listed in scheduled maintenance information and is essential to the  
life and performance of your vehicle and to its emissions system.  
For PCV valve replacement, see your authorized dealer. Refer to  
scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate intervals for  
changing the PCV valve.  
Replace the PCV valve with one that meets Ford material and  
design specifications for your vehicle, such as a Motorcraft or  
equivalent replacement part. The customer warranty may be void  
for any damage to the emissions system if such a PCV valve is not  
used.  
4For spark plug replacement, see your authorized dealer. Refer to  
scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate intervals for  
changing the spark plugs.  
Replace the spark plugs with ones that meet Ford material and  
design specifications for your vehicle, such as Motorcraft or  
equivalent replacement parts. The customer warranty may be  
void for any damage to the engine if such spark plugs are not  
used.  
251  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
252  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
253  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
ENGINE DATA  
Engine  
2.0L I4 engine  
121  
87 octane  
1–3–4–2  
Cubic inches  
Required fuel  
Firing order  
Ignition system  
Compression ratio  
Spark plug gap  
C.O.P  
10.0:1  
.051 inch +/- .002  
(1.3 mm +/- .05)  
254  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Engine drivebelt routing  
IDENTIFYING YOUR VEHICLE  
Safety Compliance Certification Label  
The National Highway Traffic Safety  
Administration Regulations require  
that a Safety Compliance  
Certification Label be affixed to a  
vehicle and prescribe where the  
Safety Compliance Certification  
Label may be located. The Safety  
Compliance Certification Label is  
located on the structure (B-Pillar)  
by the trailing edge of the driver’s  
door or the edge of the driver’s  
door.  
255  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Vehicle identification number (VIN)  
The vehicle identification number is  
located on the driver side  
instrument panel.  
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX  
Please note that in the graphic,  
XXXX is representative of your  
vehicle identification number.  
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) contains the following  
information:  
1. World manufacturer identifier  
2. Brake system / Gross Vehicle  
Weight Rating (GVWR) / Restraint  
System  
3. Vehicle line, series, body type  
4. Engine type  
5. Check digit  
6. Model year  
7. Assembly plant  
8. Production sequence number  
256  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
TRANSMISSION CODE DESIGNATIONS  
You can find a transmission code on  
the Safety Compliance Certification  
Label. The following table tells you  
which transmission each code  
represents.  
Description  
Code  
Four-speed automatic (4F27E)  
Five-speed manual (MTX75)  
2
Z
257  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
GENUINE FORD ACCESSORIES FOR YOUR VEHICLE  
A wide selection of Genuine Ford Accessories are available for your  
vehicle through your local Ford or Ford of Canada dealer. These quality  
accessories have been specifically engineered to fulfill your automotive  
needs; they are custom designed to complement the style and  
aerodynamic appearance of your vehicle. In addition, each accessory is  
made from high quality materials and meets or exceeds Ford’s rigorous  
engineering and safety specifications. Ford Motor Company will repair or  
replace any properly dealer-installed Genuine Ford Accessories found to  
be defective in factory-supplied materials or workmanship during the  
warranty period, as well as any component damaged by the defective  
accessories. The accessories will be warranted for whichever provides  
you the greatest benefit:  
12 months or 12,000 miles (20,000 km) (whichever occurs first), or  
the remainder of your new vehicle limited warranty.  
Contact your dealer for details and a copy of the warranty.  
The following is a list of several Genuine Ford Accessories. Not all  
accessories are available for all models. For a complete listing of the  
accessories that are available for your vehicle, please contact your dealer  
or visit our online store at: www.fordaccessories.com.  
Exterior style  
Bug shields  
Chrome exhaust tips  
Deflectors  
Exterior trim kits  
Fog lights  
Splash guards  
Wheels  
Interior style  
Electrochromatic compass/temperature interior mirrors  
Floor mats  
Lifestyle  
Ash cup / smoker’s package  
Cargo organization and management  
258  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Accessories  
Peace of mind  
Mobile-Ease™ hands free communication system  
Remote start  
Vehicle security systems  
Wheel locks  
For maximum vehicle performance, keep the following information in  
mind when adding accessories or equipment to your vehicle:  
When adding accessories, equipment, passengers and luggage to your  
vehicle, do not exceed the total weight capacity of the vehicle or of  
the front or rear axle (GVWR or GAWR as indicated on the Safety  
Compliance Certification label). Consult your authorized dealer for  
specific weight information.  
The Federal Communications Commission (FCC) and Canadian Radio  
Telecommunications Commission (CRTC) regulate the use of mobile  
communications systems — such as two-way radios, telephones and  
theft alarms - that are equipped with radio transmitters. Any such  
equipment installed in your vehicle should comply with FCC or CRTC  
regulations and should be installed only by a qualified service  
technician.  
Mobile communications systems may harm the operation of your  
vehicle, particularly if they are not properly designed for automotive  
use.  
To avoid interference with other vehicle functions, such as anti-lock  
braking systems, amateur radio users who install radios and antennas  
onto their vehicle should not locate the Amateur Radio Antennas in  
the area of the driver’s side hood.  
Electrical or electronic accessories or components that are added to  
the vehicle by the authorized dealer or the owner may adversely affect  
battery performance and durability.  
259  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
A
B
C
260  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Index  
Cleaning your vehicle  
D
Clutch  
E
261  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
G
F
H
I
262  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
J
M
K
Keyless entry system  
L
Lamps  
O
P
Locks  
263  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
R
S
T
Tire Pressure Monitoring  
264  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
U
V
W
265  
2009 Focus (foc)  
Owners Guide, 2nd Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Concord Camera Digital Camera 6340z User Manual
Connect Tech Network Card JB0 User Manual
Cuisinart Refrigerator CWC 800 User Manual
Danby Refrigerator DPC6012BLS User Manual
Delfield Refrigerator SAR1 S User Manual
Dimplex Indoor Fireplace 7206260100REV00 User Manual
Dymo Scale PE5R User Manual
Dyson Vacuum Cleaner DC 19 T2 User Manual
EverFocus Security Camera EAN 1350 User Manual
Foster Oven S4000 PL User Manual